• Home
  • Line#
  • Scopes#
  • Navigate#
  • Raw
  • Download
1 //
2 // Copyright (C) 2002-2005  3Dlabs Inc. Ltd.
3 // Copyright (C) 2012-2015 LunarG, Inc.
4 // Copyright (C) 2015-2018 Google, Inc.
5 // Copyright (C) 2017 ARM Limited.
6 //
7 // All rights reserved.
8 //
9 // Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
10 // modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
11 // are met:
12 //
13 //    Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
14 //    notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
15 //
16 //    Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above
17 //    copyright notice, this list of conditions and the following
18 //    disclaimer in the documentation and/or other materials provided
19 //    with the distribution.
20 //
21 //    Neither the name of 3Dlabs Inc. Ltd. nor the names of its
22 //    contributors may be used to endorse or promote products derived
23 //    from this software without specific prior written permission.
24 //
25 // THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE COPYRIGHT HOLDERS AND CONTRIBUTORS
26 // "AS IS" AND ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT
27 // LIMITED TO, THE IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS
28 // FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE
29 // COPYRIGHT HOLDERS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT,
30 // INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES (INCLUDING,
31 // BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS OR SERVICES;
32 // LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION) HOWEVER
33 // CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
34 // LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN
35 // ANY WAY OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE
36 // POSSIBILITY OF SUCH DAMAGE.
37 //
38 
39 #include "ParseHelper.h"
40 #include "Scan.h"
41 
42 #include "../OSDependent/osinclude.h"
43 #include <algorithm>
44 
45 #include "preprocessor/PpContext.h"
46 
47 extern int yyparse(glslang::TParseContext*);
48 
49 namespace glslang {
50 
TParseContext(TSymbolTable & symbolTable,TIntermediate & interm,bool parsingBuiltins,int version,EProfile profile,const SpvVersion & spvVersion,EShLanguage language,TInfoSink & infoSink,bool forwardCompatible,EShMessages messages,const TString * entryPoint)51 TParseContext::TParseContext(TSymbolTable& symbolTable, TIntermediate& interm, bool parsingBuiltins,
52                              int version, EProfile profile, const SpvVersion& spvVersion, EShLanguage language,
53                              TInfoSink& infoSink, bool forwardCompatible, EShMessages messages,
54                              const TString* entryPoint) :
55             TParseContextBase(symbolTable, interm, parsingBuiltins, version, profile, spvVersion, language,
56                               infoSink, forwardCompatible, messages, entryPoint),
57             inMain(false),
58             blockName(nullptr),
59             limits(resources.limits),
60             atomicUintOffsets(nullptr), anyIndexLimits(false)
61 {
62     // decide whether precision qualifiers should be ignored or respected
63     if (profile == EEsProfile || spvVersion.vulkan > 0) {
64         precisionManager.respectPrecisionQualifiers();
65         if (! parsingBuiltins && language == EShLangFragment && profile != EEsProfile && spvVersion.vulkan > 0)
66             precisionManager.warnAboutDefaults();
67     }
68 
69     setPrecisionDefaults();
70 
71     globalUniformDefaults.clear();
72     globalUniformDefaults.layoutMatrix = ElmColumnMajor;
73     globalUniformDefaults.layoutPacking = spvVersion.spv != 0 ? ElpStd140 : ElpShared;
74 
75     globalBufferDefaults.clear();
76     globalBufferDefaults.layoutMatrix = ElmColumnMajor;
77     globalBufferDefaults.layoutPacking = spvVersion.spv != 0 ? ElpStd430 : ElpShared;
78 
79     // use storage buffer on SPIR-V 1.3 and up
80     if (spvVersion.spv >= EShTargetSpv_1_3)
81         intermediate.setUseStorageBuffer();
82 
83     globalInputDefaults.clear();
84     globalOutputDefaults.clear();
85 
86     // "Shaders in the transform
87     // feedback capturing mode have an initial global default of
88     //     layout(xfb_buffer = 0) out;"
89     if (language == EShLangVertex ||
90         language == EShLangTessControl ||
91         language == EShLangTessEvaluation ||
92         language == EShLangGeometry)
93         globalOutputDefaults.layoutXfbBuffer = 0;
94 
95     if (language == EShLangGeometry)
96         globalOutputDefaults.layoutStream = 0;
97 
98     if (entryPoint != nullptr && entryPoint->size() > 0 && *entryPoint != "main")
99         infoSink.info.message(EPrefixError, "Source entry point must be \"main\"");
100 }
101 
~TParseContext()102 TParseContext::~TParseContext()
103 {
104     delete [] atomicUintOffsets;
105 }
106 
107 // Set up all default precisions as needed by the current environment.
108 // Intended just as a TParseContext constructor helper.
setPrecisionDefaults()109 void TParseContext::setPrecisionDefaults()
110 {
111     // Set all precision defaults to EpqNone, which is correct for all types
112     // when not obeying precision qualifiers, and correct for types that don't
113     // have defaults (thus getting an error on use) when obeying precision
114     // qualifiers.
115 
116     for (int type = 0; type < EbtNumTypes; ++type)
117         defaultPrecision[type] = EpqNone;
118 
119     for (int type = 0; type < maxSamplerIndex; ++type)
120         defaultSamplerPrecision[type] = EpqNone;
121 
122     // replace with real precision defaults for those that have them
123     if (obeyPrecisionQualifiers()) {
124         if (profile == EEsProfile) {
125             // Most don't have defaults, a few default to lowp.
126             TSampler sampler;
127             sampler.set(EbtFloat, Esd2D);
128             defaultSamplerPrecision[computeSamplerTypeIndex(sampler)] = EpqLow;
129             sampler.set(EbtFloat, EsdCube);
130             defaultSamplerPrecision[computeSamplerTypeIndex(sampler)] = EpqLow;
131             sampler.set(EbtFloat, Esd2D);
132             sampler.external = true;
133             defaultSamplerPrecision[computeSamplerTypeIndex(sampler)] = EpqLow;
134         }
135 
136         // If we are parsing built-in computational variables/functions, it is meaningful to record
137         // whether the built-in has no precision qualifier, as that ambiguity
138         // is used to resolve the precision from the supplied arguments/operands instead.
139         // So, we don't actually want to replace EpqNone with a default precision for built-ins.
140         if (! parsingBuiltins) {
141             if (profile == EEsProfile && language == EShLangFragment) {
142                 defaultPrecision[EbtInt] = EpqMedium;
143                 defaultPrecision[EbtUint] = EpqMedium;
144             } else {
145                 defaultPrecision[EbtInt] = EpqHigh;
146                 defaultPrecision[EbtUint] = EpqHigh;
147                 defaultPrecision[EbtFloat] = EpqHigh;
148             }
149 
150             if (profile != EEsProfile) {
151                 // Non-ES profile
152                 // All sampler precisions default to highp.
153                 for (int type = 0; type < maxSamplerIndex; ++type)
154                     defaultSamplerPrecision[type] = EpqHigh;
155             }
156         }
157 
158         defaultPrecision[EbtSampler] = EpqLow;
159         defaultPrecision[EbtAtomicUint] = EpqHigh;
160     }
161 }
162 
setLimits(const TBuiltInResource & r)163 void TParseContext::setLimits(const TBuiltInResource& r)
164 {
165     resources = r;
166 
167     anyIndexLimits = ! limits.generalAttributeMatrixVectorIndexing ||
168                      ! limits.generalConstantMatrixVectorIndexing ||
169                      ! limits.generalSamplerIndexing ||
170                      ! limits.generalUniformIndexing ||
171                      ! limits.generalVariableIndexing ||
172                      ! limits.generalVaryingIndexing;
173 
174     intermediate.setLimits(resources);
175 
176     // "Each binding point tracks its own current default offset for
177     // inheritance of subsequent variables using the same binding. The initial state of compilation is that all
178     // binding points have an offset of 0."
179     atomicUintOffsets = new int[resources.maxAtomicCounterBindings];
180     for (int b = 0; b < resources.maxAtomicCounterBindings; ++b)
181         atomicUintOffsets[b] = 0;
182 }
183 
184 //
185 // Parse an array of strings using yyparse, going through the
186 // preprocessor to tokenize the shader strings, then through
187 // the GLSL scanner.
188 //
189 // Returns true for successful acceptance of the shader, false if any errors.
190 //
parseShaderStrings(TPpContext & ppContext,TInputScanner & input,bool versionWillBeError)191 bool TParseContext::parseShaderStrings(TPpContext& ppContext, TInputScanner& input, bool versionWillBeError)
192 {
193     currentScanner = &input;
194     ppContext.setInput(input, versionWillBeError);
195     yyparse(this);
196 
197     finish();
198 
199     return numErrors == 0;
200 }
201 
202 // This is called from bison when it has a parse (syntax) error
203 // Note though that to stop cascading errors, we set EOF, which
204 // will usually cause a syntax error, so be more accurate that
205 // compilation is terminating.
parserError(const char * s)206 void TParseContext::parserError(const char* s)
207 {
208     if (! getScanner()->atEndOfInput() || numErrors == 0)
209         error(getCurrentLoc(), "", "", s, "");
210     else
211         error(getCurrentLoc(), "compilation terminated", "", "");
212 }
213 
handlePragma(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TVector<TString> & tokens)214 void TParseContext::handlePragma(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TVector<TString>& tokens)
215 {
216     if (pragmaCallback)
217         pragmaCallback(loc.line, tokens);
218 
219     if (tokens.size() == 0)
220         return;
221 
222     if (tokens[0].compare("optimize") == 0) {
223         if (tokens.size() != 4) {
224             error(loc, "optimize pragma syntax is incorrect", "#pragma", "");
225             return;
226         }
227 
228         if (tokens[1].compare("(") != 0) {
229             error(loc, "\"(\" expected after 'optimize' keyword", "#pragma", "");
230             return;
231         }
232 
233         if (tokens[2].compare("on") == 0)
234             contextPragma.optimize = true;
235         else if (tokens[2].compare("off") == 0)
236             contextPragma.optimize = false;
237         else {
238             error(loc, "\"on\" or \"off\" expected after '(' for 'optimize' pragma", "#pragma", "");
239             return;
240         }
241 
242         if (tokens[3].compare(")") != 0) {
243             error(loc, "\")\" expected to end 'optimize' pragma", "#pragma", "");
244             return;
245         }
246     } else if (tokens[0].compare("debug") == 0) {
247         if (tokens.size() != 4) {
248             error(loc, "debug pragma syntax is incorrect", "#pragma", "");
249             return;
250         }
251 
252         if (tokens[1].compare("(") != 0) {
253             error(loc, "\"(\" expected after 'debug' keyword", "#pragma", "");
254             return;
255         }
256 
257         if (tokens[2].compare("on") == 0)
258             contextPragma.debug = true;
259         else if (tokens[2].compare("off") == 0)
260             contextPragma.debug = false;
261         else {
262             error(loc, "\"on\" or \"off\" expected after '(' for 'debug' pragma", "#pragma", "");
263             return;
264         }
265 
266         if (tokens[3].compare(")") != 0) {
267             error(loc, "\")\" expected to end 'debug' pragma", "#pragma", "");
268             return;
269         }
270     } else if (spvVersion.spv > 0 && tokens[0].compare("use_storage_buffer") == 0) {
271         if (tokens.size() != 1)
272             error(loc, "extra tokens", "#pragma", "");
273         intermediate.setUseStorageBuffer();
274     } else if (spvVersion.spv > 0 && tokens[0].compare("use_vulkan_memory_model") == 0) {
275         if (tokens.size() != 1)
276             error(loc, "extra tokens", "#pragma", "");
277         intermediate.setUseVulkanMemoryModel();
278     } else if (tokens[0].compare("once") == 0) {
279         warn(loc, "not implemented", "#pragma once", "");
280     } else if (tokens[0].compare("glslang_binary_double_output") == 0)
281         intermediate.setBinaryDoubleOutput();
282 }
283 
284 //
285 // Handle seeing a variable identifier in the grammar.
286 //
handleVariable(const TSourceLoc & loc,TSymbol * symbol,const TString * string)287 TIntermTyped* TParseContext::handleVariable(const TSourceLoc& loc, TSymbol* symbol, const TString* string)
288 {
289     TIntermTyped* node = nullptr;
290 
291     // Error check for requiring specific extensions present.
292     if (symbol && symbol->getNumExtensions())
293         requireExtensions(loc, symbol->getNumExtensions(), symbol->getExtensions(), symbol->getName().c_str());
294 
295     if (symbol && symbol->isReadOnly()) {
296         // All shared things containing an unsized array must be copied up
297         // on first use, so that all future references will share its array structure,
298         // so that editing the implicit size will effect all nodes consuming it,
299         // and so that editing the implicit size won't change the shared one.
300         //
301         // If this is a variable or a block, check it and all it contains, but if this
302         // is a member of an anonymous block, check the whole block, as the whole block
303         // will need to be copied up if it contains an unsized array.
304         if (symbol->getType().containsUnsizedArray() ||
305             (symbol->getAsAnonMember() &&
306              symbol->getAsAnonMember()->getAnonContainer().getType().containsUnsizedArray()))
307             makeEditable(symbol);
308     }
309 
310     const TVariable* variable;
311     const TAnonMember* anon = symbol ? symbol->getAsAnonMember() : nullptr;
312     if (anon) {
313         // It was a member of an anonymous container.
314 
315         // The "getNumExtensions()" mechanism above doesn't yet work for block members
316         blockMemberExtensionCheck(loc, nullptr, *string);
317 
318         // Create a subtree for its dereference.
319         variable = anon->getAnonContainer().getAsVariable();
320         TIntermTyped* container = intermediate.addSymbol(*variable, loc);
321         TIntermTyped* constNode = intermediate.addConstantUnion(anon->getMemberNumber(), loc);
322         node = intermediate.addIndex(EOpIndexDirectStruct, container, constNode, loc);
323 
324         node->setType(*(*variable->getType().getStruct())[anon->getMemberNumber()].type);
325         if (node->getType().hiddenMember())
326             error(loc, "member of nameless block was not redeclared", string->c_str(), "");
327     } else {
328         // Not a member of an anonymous container.
329 
330         // The symbol table search was done in the lexical phase.
331         // See if it was a variable.
332         variable = symbol ? symbol->getAsVariable() : nullptr;
333         if (variable) {
334             if ((variable->getType().getBasicType() == EbtBlock ||
335                  variable->getType().getBasicType() == EbtStruct) && variable->getType().getStruct() == nullptr) {
336                 error(loc, "cannot be used (maybe an instance name is needed)", string->c_str(), "");
337                 variable = nullptr;
338             }
339         } else {
340             if (symbol)
341                 error(loc, "variable name expected", string->c_str(), "");
342         }
343 
344         // Recovery, if it wasn't found or was not a variable.
345         if (! variable)
346             variable = new TVariable(string, TType(EbtVoid));
347 
348         if (variable->getType().getQualifier().isFrontEndConstant())
349             node = intermediate.addConstantUnion(variable->getConstArray(), variable->getType(), loc);
350         else
351             node = intermediate.addSymbol(*variable, loc);
352     }
353 
354     if (variable->getType().getQualifier().isIo())
355         intermediate.addIoAccessed(*string);
356 
357     if (variable->getType().getBasicType() == EbtReference &&
358         variable->getType().getQualifier().isMemory()) {
359         intermediate.setUseVulkanMemoryModel();
360     }
361 
362     return node;
363 }
364 
365 //
366 // Handle seeing a base[index] dereference in the grammar.
367 //
handleBracketDereference(const TSourceLoc & loc,TIntermTyped * base,TIntermTyped * index)368 TIntermTyped* TParseContext::handleBracketDereference(const TSourceLoc& loc, TIntermTyped* base, TIntermTyped* index)
369 {
370     int indexValue = 0;
371     if (index->getQualifier().isFrontEndConstant())
372         indexValue = index->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
373 
374     // basic type checks...
375     variableCheck(base);
376 
377     if (! base->isArray() && ! base->isMatrix() && ! base->isVector()) {
378         if (base->getAsSymbolNode())
379             error(loc, " left of '[' is not of type array, matrix, or vector ", base->getAsSymbolNode()->getName().c_str(), "");
380         else
381             error(loc, " left of '[' is not of type array, matrix, or vector ", "expression", "");
382 
383         // Insert dummy error-recovery result
384         return intermediate.addConstantUnion(0.0, EbtFloat, loc);
385     }
386 
387     if (!base->isArray() && base->isVector()) {
388         if (base->getType().containsBasicType(EbtFloat16))
389             requireFloat16Arithmetic(loc, "[", "does not operate on types containing float16");
390         if (base->getType().contains16BitInt())
391             requireInt16Arithmetic(loc, "[", "does not operate on types containing (u)int16");
392         if (base->getType().contains8BitInt())
393             requireInt8Arithmetic(loc, "[", "does not operate on types containing (u)int8");
394     }
395 
396     // check for constant folding
397     if (base->getType().getQualifier().isFrontEndConstant() && index->getQualifier().isFrontEndConstant()) {
398         // both base and index are front-end constants
399         checkIndex(loc, base->getType(), indexValue);
400         return intermediate.foldDereference(base, indexValue, loc);
401     }
402 
403     // at least one of base and index is not a front-end constant variable...
404     TIntermTyped* result = nullptr;
405     if (index->getQualifier().isFrontEndConstant())
406         checkIndex(loc, base->getType(), indexValue);
407 
408     if (base->getAsSymbolNode() && isIoResizeArray(base->getType()))
409         handleIoResizeArrayAccess(loc, base);
410 
411     if (index->getQualifier().isFrontEndConstant()) {
412         if (base->getType().isUnsizedArray()) {
413             base->getWritableType().updateImplicitArraySize(indexValue + 1);
414 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
415             // For 2D per-view builtin arrays, update the inner dimension size in parent type
416             if (base->getQualifier().isPerView() && base->getQualifier().builtIn != EbvNone) {
417                 TIntermBinary* binaryNode = base->getAsBinaryNode();
418                 if (binaryNode) {
419                     TType& leftType = binaryNode->getLeft()->getWritableType();
420                     TArraySizes& arraySizes = *leftType.getArraySizes();
421                     assert(arraySizes.getNumDims() == 2);
422                     arraySizes.setDimSize(1, std::max(arraySizes.getDimSize(1), indexValue + 1));
423                 }
424             }
425 #endif
426         } else
427             checkIndex(loc, base->getType(), indexValue);
428         result = intermediate.addIndex(EOpIndexDirect, base, index, loc);
429     } else {
430         if (base->getType().isUnsizedArray()) {
431             // we have a variable index into an unsized array, which is okay,
432             // depending on the situation
433             if (base->getAsSymbolNode() && isIoResizeArray(base->getType()))
434                 error(loc, "", "[", "array must be sized by a redeclaration or layout qualifier before being indexed with a variable");
435             else {
436                 // it is okay for a run-time sized array
437                 checkRuntimeSizable(loc, *base);
438             }
439             base->getWritableType().setArrayVariablyIndexed();
440         }
441         if (base->getBasicType() == EbtBlock) {
442             if (base->getQualifier().storage == EvqBuffer)
443                 requireProfile(base->getLoc(), ~EEsProfile, "variable indexing buffer block array");
444             else if (base->getQualifier().storage == EvqUniform)
445                 profileRequires(base->getLoc(), EEsProfile, 320, Num_AEP_gpu_shader5, AEP_gpu_shader5,
446                                 "variable indexing uniform block array");
447             else {
448                 // input/output blocks either don't exist or can be variable indexed
449             }
450         } else if (language == EShLangFragment && base->getQualifier().isPipeOutput())
451             requireProfile(base->getLoc(), ~EEsProfile, "variable indexing fragment shader output array");
452         else if (base->getBasicType() == EbtSampler && version >= 130) {
453             const char* explanation = "variable indexing sampler array";
454             requireProfile(base->getLoc(), EEsProfile | ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, explanation);
455             profileRequires(base->getLoc(), EEsProfile, 320, Num_AEP_gpu_shader5, AEP_gpu_shader5, explanation);
456             profileRequires(base->getLoc(), ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, 400, nullptr, explanation);
457         }
458 
459         result = intermediate.addIndex(EOpIndexIndirect, base, index, loc);
460     }
461 
462     // Insert valid dereferenced result
463     TType newType(base->getType(), 0);  // dereferenced type
464     if (base->getType().getQualifier().isConstant() && index->getQualifier().isConstant()) {
465         newType.getQualifier().storage = EvqConst;
466         // If base or index is a specialization constant, the result should also be a specialization constant.
467         if (base->getType().getQualifier().isSpecConstant() || index->getQualifier().isSpecConstant()) {
468             newType.getQualifier().makeSpecConstant();
469         }
470     } else {
471         newType.getQualifier().makePartialTemporary();
472     }
473     result->setType(newType);
474 
475     // Propagate nonuniform
476     if (base->getQualifier().isNonUniform() || index->getQualifier().isNonUniform())
477         result->getWritableType().getQualifier().nonUniform = true;
478 
479     if (anyIndexLimits)
480         handleIndexLimits(loc, base, index);
481 
482     return result;
483 }
484 
485 // for ES 2.0 (version 100) limitations for almost all index operations except vertex-shader uniforms
handleIndexLimits(const TSourceLoc &,TIntermTyped * base,TIntermTyped * index)486 void TParseContext::handleIndexLimits(const TSourceLoc& /*loc*/, TIntermTyped* base, TIntermTyped* index)
487 {
488     if ((! limits.generalSamplerIndexing && base->getBasicType() == EbtSampler) ||
489         (! limits.generalUniformIndexing && base->getQualifier().isUniformOrBuffer() && language != EShLangVertex) ||
490         (! limits.generalAttributeMatrixVectorIndexing && base->getQualifier().isPipeInput() && language == EShLangVertex && (base->getType().isMatrix() || base->getType().isVector())) ||
491         (! limits.generalConstantMatrixVectorIndexing && base->getAsConstantUnion()) ||
492         (! limits.generalVariableIndexing && ! base->getType().getQualifier().isUniformOrBuffer() &&
493                                              ! base->getType().getQualifier().isPipeInput() &&
494                                              ! base->getType().getQualifier().isPipeOutput() &&
495                                              ! base->getType().getQualifier().isConstant()) ||
496         (! limits.generalVaryingIndexing && (base->getType().getQualifier().isPipeInput() ||
497                                                 base->getType().getQualifier().isPipeOutput()))) {
498         // it's too early to know what the inductive variables are, save it for post processing
499         needsIndexLimitationChecking.push_back(index);
500     }
501 }
502 
503 // Make a shared symbol have a non-shared version that can be edited by the current
504 // compile, such that editing its type will not change the shared version and will
505 // effect all nodes sharing it.
makeEditable(TSymbol * & symbol)506 void TParseContext::makeEditable(TSymbol*& symbol)
507 {
508     TParseContextBase::makeEditable(symbol);
509 
510     // See if it's tied to IO resizing
511     if (isIoResizeArray(symbol->getType()))
512         ioArraySymbolResizeList.push_back(symbol);
513 }
514 
515 // Return true if this is a geometry shader input array or tessellation control output array
516 // or mesh shader output array.
isIoResizeArray(const TType & type) const517 bool TParseContext::isIoResizeArray(const TType& type) const
518 {
519     return type.isArray() &&
520            ((language == EShLangGeometry    && type.getQualifier().storage == EvqVaryingIn) ||
521             (language == EShLangTessControl && type.getQualifier().storage == EvqVaryingOut && ! type.getQualifier().patch)
522 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
523             ||
524             (language == EShLangFragment && type.getQualifier().storage == EvqVaryingIn &&  type.getQualifier().pervertexNV) ||
525             (language == EShLangMeshNV && type.getQualifier().storage == EvqVaryingOut && !type.getQualifier().perTaskNV)
526 
527 #endif
528             );
529 }
530 
531 // If an array is not isIoResizeArray() but is an io array, make sure it has the right size
fixIoArraySize(const TSourceLoc & loc,TType & type)532 void TParseContext::fixIoArraySize(const TSourceLoc& loc, TType& type)
533 {
534     if (! type.isArray() || type.getQualifier().patch || symbolTable.atBuiltInLevel())
535         return;
536 
537     assert(! isIoResizeArray(type));
538 
539     if (type.getQualifier().storage != EvqVaryingIn || type.getQualifier().patch)
540         return;
541 
542     if (language == EShLangTessControl || language == EShLangTessEvaluation) {
543         if (type.getOuterArraySize() != resources.maxPatchVertices) {
544             if (type.isSizedArray())
545                 error(loc, "tessellation input array size must be gl_MaxPatchVertices or implicitly sized", "[]", "");
546             type.changeOuterArraySize(resources.maxPatchVertices);
547         }
548     }
549 }
550 
551 // Issue any errors if the non-array object is missing arrayness WRT
552 // shader I/O that has array requirements.
553 // All arrayness checking is handled in array paths, this is for
ioArrayCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TType & type,const TString & identifier)554 void TParseContext::ioArrayCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TType& type, const TString& identifier)
555 {
556     if (! type.isArray() && ! symbolTable.atBuiltInLevel()) {
557         if (type.getQualifier().isArrayedIo(language)
558 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
559             && !type.getQualifier().layoutPassthrough
560 #endif
561            )
562             error(loc, "type must be an array:", type.getStorageQualifierString(), identifier.c_str());
563     }
564 }
565 
566 // Handle a dereference of a geometry shader input array or tessellation control output array.
567 // See ioArraySymbolResizeList comment in ParseHelper.h.
568 //
handleIoResizeArrayAccess(const TSourceLoc &,TIntermTyped * base)569 void TParseContext::handleIoResizeArrayAccess(const TSourceLoc& /*loc*/, TIntermTyped* base)
570 {
571     TIntermSymbol* symbolNode = base->getAsSymbolNode();
572     assert(symbolNode);
573     if (! symbolNode)
574         return;
575 
576     // fix array size, if it can be fixed and needs to be fixed (will allow variable indexing)
577     if (symbolNode->getType().isUnsizedArray()) {
578         int newSize = getIoArrayImplicitSize(symbolNode->getType().getQualifier().isPerPrimitive());
579         if (newSize > 0)
580             symbolNode->getWritableType().changeOuterArraySize(newSize);
581     }
582 }
583 
584 // If there has been an input primitive declaration (geometry shader) or an output
585 // number of vertices declaration(tessellation shader), make sure all input array types
586 // match it in size.  Types come either from nodes in the AST or symbols in the
587 // symbol table.
588 //
589 // Types without an array size will be given one.
590 // Types already having a size that is wrong will get an error.
591 //
checkIoArraysConsistency(const TSourceLoc & loc,bool tailOnly,bool isPerPrimitive)592 void TParseContext::checkIoArraysConsistency(const TSourceLoc& loc, bool tailOnly, bool isPerPrimitive)
593 {
594     int requiredSize = getIoArrayImplicitSize(isPerPrimitive);
595     if (requiredSize == 0)
596         return;
597 
598     const char* feature;
599     if (language == EShLangGeometry)
600         feature = TQualifier::getGeometryString(intermediate.getInputPrimitive());
601     else if (language == EShLangTessControl
602 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
603           || language == EShLangFragment
604 #endif
605         )
606 
607         feature = "vertices";
608 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
609      else if (language == EShLangMeshNV) {
610         feature = isPerPrimitive ? "max_primitives" : "max_vertices";
611      }
612 #endif
613     else
614         feature = "unknown";
615 
616     if (tailOnly) {
617         checkIoArrayConsistency(loc, requiredSize, feature, ioArraySymbolResizeList.back()->getWritableType(), ioArraySymbolResizeList.back()->getName());
618         return;
619     }
620 
621     for (size_t i = 0; i < ioArraySymbolResizeList.size(); ++i)
622         checkIoArrayConsistency(loc, requiredSize, feature, ioArraySymbolResizeList[i]->getWritableType(), ioArraySymbolResizeList[i]->getName());
623 }
624 
getIoArrayImplicitSize(bool isPerPrimitive) const625 int TParseContext::getIoArrayImplicitSize(bool isPerPrimitive) const
626 {
627     if (language == EShLangGeometry)
628         return TQualifier::mapGeometryToSize(intermediate.getInputPrimitive());
629     else if (language == EShLangTessControl)
630         return intermediate.getVertices() != TQualifier::layoutNotSet ? intermediate.getVertices() : 0;
631 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
632     else if (language == EShLangFragment)
633         return 3; //Number of vertices for Fragment shader is always three.
634     else if (language == EShLangMeshNV) {
635         if (isPerPrimitive) {
636             return intermediate.getPrimitives() != TQualifier::layoutNotSet ? intermediate.getPrimitives() : 0;
637         } else {
638             return intermediate.getVertices() != TQualifier::layoutNotSet ? intermediate.getVertices() : 0;
639         }
640     }
641 #endif
642 
643     else
644         return 0;
645 }
646 
checkIoArrayConsistency(const TSourceLoc & loc,int requiredSize,const char * feature,TType & type,const TString & name)647 void TParseContext::checkIoArrayConsistency(const TSourceLoc& loc, int requiredSize, const char* feature, TType& type, const TString& name)
648 {
649     if (type.isUnsizedArray())
650         type.changeOuterArraySize(requiredSize);
651     else if (type.getOuterArraySize() != requiredSize) {
652         if (language == EShLangGeometry)
653             error(loc, "inconsistent input primitive for array size of", feature, name.c_str());
654         else if (language == EShLangTessControl)
655             error(loc, "inconsistent output number of vertices for array size of", feature, name.c_str());
656 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
657         else if (language == EShLangFragment) {
658             if (type.getOuterArraySize() > requiredSize)
659                 error(loc, " cannot be greater than 3 for pervertexNV", feature, name.c_str());
660         }
661         else if (language == EShLangMeshNV)
662             error(loc, "inconsistent output array size of", feature, name.c_str());
663 #endif
664         else
665             assert(0);
666     }
667 }
668 
669 // Handle seeing a binary node with a math operation.
670 // Returns nullptr if not semantically allowed.
handleBinaryMath(const TSourceLoc & loc,const char * str,TOperator op,TIntermTyped * left,TIntermTyped * right)671 TIntermTyped* TParseContext::handleBinaryMath(const TSourceLoc& loc, const char* str, TOperator op, TIntermTyped* left, TIntermTyped* right)
672 {
673     rValueErrorCheck(loc, str, left->getAsTyped());
674     rValueErrorCheck(loc, str, right->getAsTyped());
675 
676     bool allowed = true;
677     switch (op) {
678     // TODO: Bring more source language-specific checks up from intermediate.cpp
679     // to the specific parse helpers for that source language.
680     case EOpLessThan:
681     case EOpGreaterThan:
682     case EOpLessThanEqual:
683     case EOpGreaterThanEqual:
684         if (! left->isScalar() || ! right->isScalar())
685             allowed = false;
686         break;
687     default:
688         break;
689     }
690 
691     if (((left->getType().containsBasicType(EbtFloat16) || right->getType().containsBasicType(EbtFloat16)) && !float16Arithmetic()) ||
692         ((left->getType().contains16BitInt() || right->getType().contains16BitInt()) && !int16Arithmetic()) ||
693         ((left->getType().contains8BitInt() || right->getType().contains8BitInt()) && !int8Arithmetic())) {
694         allowed = false;
695     }
696 
697     TIntermTyped* result = nullptr;
698     if (allowed)
699         result = intermediate.addBinaryMath(op, left, right, loc);
700 
701     if (result == nullptr)
702         binaryOpError(loc, str, left->getCompleteString(), right->getCompleteString());
703 
704     return result;
705 }
706 
707 // Handle seeing a unary node with a math operation.
handleUnaryMath(const TSourceLoc & loc,const char * str,TOperator op,TIntermTyped * childNode)708 TIntermTyped* TParseContext::handleUnaryMath(const TSourceLoc& loc, const char* str, TOperator op, TIntermTyped* childNode)
709 {
710     rValueErrorCheck(loc, str, childNode);
711 
712     bool allowed = true;
713     if ((childNode->getType().containsBasicType(EbtFloat16) && !float16Arithmetic()) ||
714         (childNode->getType().contains16BitInt() && !int16Arithmetic()) ||
715         (childNode->getType().contains8BitInt() && !int8Arithmetic())) {
716         allowed = false;
717     }
718 
719     TIntermTyped* result = nullptr;
720 
721     if (allowed)
722         result = intermediate.addUnaryMath(op, childNode, loc);
723 
724     if (result)
725         return result;
726     else
727         unaryOpError(loc, str, childNode->getCompleteString());
728 
729     return childNode;
730 }
731 
732 //
733 // Handle seeing a base.field dereference in the grammar.
734 //
handleDotDereference(const TSourceLoc & loc,TIntermTyped * base,const TString & field)735 TIntermTyped* TParseContext::handleDotDereference(const TSourceLoc& loc, TIntermTyped* base, const TString& field)
736 {
737     variableCheck(base);
738 
739     //
740     // .length() can't be resolved until we later see the function-calling syntax.
741     // Save away the name in the AST for now.  Processing is completed in
742     // handleLengthMethod().
743     //
744     if (field == "length") {
745         if (base->isArray()) {
746             profileRequires(loc, ENoProfile, 120, E_GL_3DL_array_objects, ".length");
747             profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, ".length");
748         } else if (base->isVector() || base->isMatrix()) {
749             const char* feature = ".length() on vectors and matrices";
750             requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, feature);
751             profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 420, E_GL_ARB_shading_language_420pack, feature);
752         } else {
753             error(loc, "does not operate on this type:", field.c_str(), base->getType().getCompleteString().c_str());
754 
755             return base;
756         }
757 
758         return intermediate.addMethod(base, TType(EbtInt), &field, loc);
759     }
760 
761     // It's not .length() if we get to here.
762 
763     if (base->isArray()) {
764         error(loc, "cannot apply to an array:", ".", field.c_str());
765 
766         return base;
767     }
768 
769     // It's neither an array nor .length() if we get here,
770     // leaving swizzles and struct/block dereferences.
771 
772     TIntermTyped* result = base;
773     if ((base->isVector() || base->isScalar()) &&
774         (base->isFloatingDomain() || base->isIntegerDomain() || base->getBasicType() == EbtBool)) {
775         if (base->isScalar()) {
776             const char* dotFeature = "scalar swizzle";
777             requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, dotFeature);
778             profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 420, E_GL_ARB_shading_language_420pack, dotFeature);
779         }
780 
781         TSwizzleSelectors<TVectorSelector> selectors;
782         parseSwizzleSelector(loc, field, base->getVectorSize(), selectors);
783 
784         if (base->isVector() && selectors.size() != 1 && base->getType().containsBasicType(EbtFloat16))
785             requireFloat16Arithmetic(loc, ".", "can't swizzle types containing float16");
786         if (base->isVector() && selectors.size() != 1 && base->getType().contains16BitInt())
787             requireInt16Arithmetic(loc, ".", "can't swizzle types containing (u)int16");
788         if (base->isVector() && selectors.size() != 1 && base->getType().contains8BitInt())
789             requireInt8Arithmetic(loc, ".", "can't swizzle types containing (u)int8");
790 
791         if (base->isScalar()) {
792             if (selectors.size() == 1)
793                 return result;
794             else {
795                 TType type(base->getBasicType(), EvqTemporary, selectors.size());
796                 // Swizzle operations propagate specialization-constantness
797                 if (base->getQualifier().isSpecConstant())
798                     type.getQualifier().makeSpecConstant();
799                 return addConstructor(loc, base, type);
800             }
801         }
802 
803         if (base->getType().getQualifier().isFrontEndConstant())
804             result = intermediate.foldSwizzle(base, selectors, loc);
805         else {
806             if (selectors.size() == 1) {
807                 TIntermTyped* index = intermediate.addConstantUnion(selectors[0], loc);
808                 result = intermediate.addIndex(EOpIndexDirect, base, index, loc);
809                 result->setType(TType(base->getBasicType(), EvqTemporary, base->getType().getQualifier().precision));
810             } else {
811                 TIntermTyped* index = intermediate.addSwizzle(selectors, loc);
812                 result = intermediate.addIndex(EOpVectorSwizzle, base, index, loc);
813                 result->setType(TType(base->getBasicType(), EvqTemporary, base->getType().getQualifier().precision, selectors.size()));
814             }
815             // Swizzle operations propagate specialization-constantness
816             if (base->getType().getQualifier().isSpecConstant())
817                 result->getWritableType().getQualifier().makeSpecConstant();
818         }
819     } else if (base->getBasicType() == EbtStruct ||
820                base->getBasicType() == EbtBlock ||
821                base->getBasicType() == EbtReference) {
822         const TTypeList* fields = base->getBasicType() == EbtReference ?
823                                                             base->getType().getReferentType()->getStruct() :
824                                                             base->getType().getStruct();
825         bool fieldFound = false;
826         int member;
827         for (member = 0; member < (int)fields->size(); ++member) {
828             if ((*fields)[member].type->getFieldName() == field) {
829                 fieldFound = true;
830                 break;
831             }
832         }
833         if (fieldFound) {
834             if (base->getType().getQualifier().isFrontEndConstant())
835                 result = intermediate.foldDereference(base, member, loc);
836             else {
837                 blockMemberExtensionCheck(loc, base, field);
838                 TIntermTyped* index = intermediate.addConstantUnion(member, loc);
839                 result = intermediate.addIndex(EOpIndexDirectStruct, base, index, loc);
840                 result->setType(*(*fields)[member].type);
841                 if ((*fields)[member].type->getQualifier().isIo())
842                     intermediate.addIoAccessed(field);
843             }
844         } else
845             error(loc, "no such field in structure", field.c_str(), "");
846     } else
847         error(loc, "does not apply to this type:", field.c_str(), base->getType().getCompleteString().c_str());
848 
849     // Propagate noContraction up the dereference chain
850     if (base->getQualifier().noContraction)
851         result->getWritableType().getQualifier().noContraction = true;
852 
853     // Propagate nonuniform
854     if (base->getQualifier().isNonUniform())
855         result->getWritableType().getQualifier().nonUniform = true;
856 
857     return result;
858 }
859 
blockMemberExtensionCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TIntermTyped *,const TString & field)860 void TParseContext::blockMemberExtensionCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TIntermTyped* /*base*/, const TString& field)
861 {
862     if (profile == EEsProfile && field == "gl_PointSize") {
863         if (language == EShLangGeometry)
864             requireExtensions(loc, Num_AEP_geometry_point_size, AEP_geometry_point_size, "gl_PointSize");
865         else if (language == EShLangTessControl || language == EShLangTessEvaluation)
866             requireExtensions(loc, Num_AEP_tessellation_point_size, AEP_tessellation_point_size, "gl_PointSize");
867     }
868 }
869 
870 //
871 // Handle seeing a function declarator in the grammar.  This is the precursor
872 // to recognizing a function prototype or function definition.
873 //
handleFunctionDeclarator(const TSourceLoc & loc,TFunction & function,bool prototype)874 TFunction* TParseContext::handleFunctionDeclarator(const TSourceLoc& loc, TFunction& function, bool prototype)
875 {
876     // ES can't declare prototypes inside functions
877     if (! symbolTable.atGlobalLevel())
878         requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, "local function declaration");
879 
880     //
881     // Multiple declarations of the same function name are allowed.
882     //
883     // If this is a definition, the definition production code will check for redefinitions
884     // (we don't know at this point if it's a definition or not).
885     //
886     // Redeclarations (full signature match) are allowed.  But, return types and parameter qualifiers must also match.
887     //  - except ES 100, which only allows a single prototype
888     //
889     // ES 100 does not allow redefining, but does allow overloading of built-in functions.
890     // ES 300 does not allow redefining or overloading of built-in functions.
891     //
892     bool builtIn;
893     TSymbol* symbol = symbolTable.find(function.getMangledName(), &builtIn);
894     if (symbol && symbol->getAsFunction() && builtIn)
895         requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, "redefinition of built-in function");
896     const TFunction* prevDec = symbol ? symbol->getAsFunction() : 0;
897     if (prevDec) {
898         if (prevDec->isPrototyped() && prototype)
899             profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, "multiple prototypes for same function");
900         if (prevDec->getType() != function.getType())
901             error(loc, "overloaded functions must have the same return type", function.getName().c_str(), "");
902         for (int i = 0; i < prevDec->getParamCount(); ++i) {
903             if ((*prevDec)[i].type->getQualifier().storage != function[i].type->getQualifier().storage)
904                 error(loc, "overloaded functions must have the same parameter storage qualifiers for argument", function[i].type->getStorageQualifierString(), "%d", i+1);
905 
906             if ((*prevDec)[i].type->getQualifier().precision != function[i].type->getQualifier().precision)
907                 error(loc, "overloaded functions must have the same parameter precision qualifiers for argument", function[i].type->getPrecisionQualifierString(), "%d", i+1);
908         }
909     }
910 
911     arrayObjectCheck(loc, function.getType(), "array in function return type");
912 
913     if (prototype) {
914         // All built-in functions are defined, even though they don't have a body.
915         // Count their prototype as a definition instead.
916         if (symbolTable.atBuiltInLevel())
917             function.setDefined();
918         else {
919             if (prevDec && ! builtIn)
920                 symbol->getAsFunction()->setPrototyped();  // need a writable one, but like having prevDec as a const
921             function.setPrototyped();
922         }
923     }
924 
925     // This insert won't actually insert it if it's a duplicate signature, but it will still check for
926     // other forms of name collisions.
927     if (! symbolTable.insert(function))
928         error(loc, "function name is redeclaration of existing name", function.getName().c_str(), "");
929 
930     //
931     // If this is a redeclaration, it could also be a definition,
932     // in which case, we need to use the parameter names from this one, and not the one that's
933     // being redeclared.  So, pass back this declaration, not the one in the symbol table.
934     //
935     return &function;
936 }
937 
938 //
939 // Handle seeing the function prototype in front of a function definition in the grammar.
940 // The body is handled after this function returns.
941 //
handleFunctionDefinition(const TSourceLoc & loc,TFunction & function)942 TIntermAggregate* TParseContext::handleFunctionDefinition(const TSourceLoc& loc, TFunction& function)
943 {
944     currentCaller = function.getMangledName();
945     TSymbol* symbol = symbolTable.find(function.getMangledName());
946     TFunction* prevDec = symbol ? symbol->getAsFunction() : nullptr;
947 
948     if (! prevDec)
949         error(loc, "can't find function", function.getName().c_str(), "");
950     // Note:  'prevDec' could be 'function' if this is the first time we've seen function
951     // as it would have just been put in the symbol table.  Otherwise, we're looking up
952     // an earlier occurrence.
953 
954     if (prevDec && prevDec->isDefined()) {
955         // Then this function already has a body.
956         error(loc, "function already has a body", function.getName().c_str(), "");
957     }
958     if (prevDec && ! prevDec->isDefined()) {
959         prevDec->setDefined();
960 
961         // Remember the return type for later checking for RETURN statements.
962         currentFunctionType = &(prevDec->getType());
963     } else
964         currentFunctionType = new TType(EbtVoid);
965     functionReturnsValue = false;
966 
967     // Check for entry point
968     if (function.getName().compare(intermediate.getEntryPointName().c_str()) == 0) {
969         intermediate.setEntryPointMangledName(function.getMangledName().c_str());
970         intermediate.incrementEntryPointCount();
971         inMain = true;
972     } else
973         inMain = false;
974 
975     //
976     // Raise error message if main function takes any parameters or returns anything other than void
977     //
978     if (inMain) {
979         if (function.getParamCount() > 0)
980             error(loc, "function cannot take any parameter(s)", function.getName().c_str(), "");
981         if (function.getType().getBasicType() != EbtVoid)
982             error(loc, "", function.getType().getBasicTypeString().c_str(), "entry point cannot return a value");
983     }
984 
985     //
986     // New symbol table scope for body of function plus its arguments
987     //
988     symbolTable.push();
989 
990     //
991     // Insert parameters into the symbol table.
992     // If the parameter has no name, it's not an error, just don't insert it
993     // (could be used for unused args).
994     //
995     // Also, accumulate the list of parameters into the HIL, so lower level code
996     // knows where to find parameters.
997     //
998     TIntermAggregate* paramNodes = new TIntermAggregate;
999     for (int i = 0; i < function.getParamCount(); i++) {
1000         TParameter& param = function[i];
1001         if (param.name != nullptr) {
1002             TVariable *variable = new TVariable(param.name, *param.type);
1003 
1004             // Insert the parameters with name in the symbol table.
1005             if (! symbolTable.insert(*variable))
1006                 error(loc, "redefinition", variable->getName().c_str(), "");
1007             else {
1008                 // Transfer ownership of name pointer to symbol table.
1009                 param.name = nullptr;
1010 
1011                 // Add the parameter to the HIL
1012                 paramNodes = intermediate.growAggregate(paramNodes,
1013                                                         intermediate.addSymbol(*variable, loc),
1014                                                         loc);
1015             }
1016         } else
1017             paramNodes = intermediate.growAggregate(paramNodes, intermediate.addSymbol(*param.type, loc), loc);
1018     }
1019     intermediate.setAggregateOperator(paramNodes, EOpParameters, TType(EbtVoid), loc);
1020     loopNestingLevel = 0;
1021     statementNestingLevel = 0;
1022     controlFlowNestingLevel = 0;
1023     postEntryPointReturn = false;
1024 
1025     return paramNodes;
1026 }
1027 
1028 //
1029 // Handle seeing function call syntax in the grammar, which could be any of
1030 //  - .length() method
1031 //  - constructor
1032 //  - a call to a built-in function mapped to an operator
1033 //  - a call to a built-in function that will remain a function call (e.g., texturing)
1034 //  - user function
1035 //  - subroutine call (not implemented yet)
1036 //
handleFunctionCall(const TSourceLoc & loc,TFunction * function,TIntermNode * arguments)1037 TIntermTyped* TParseContext::handleFunctionCall(const TSourceLoc& loc, TFunction* function, TIntermNode* arguments)
1038 {
1039     TIntermTyped* result = nullptr;
1040 
1041     if (function->getBuiltInOp() == EOpArrayLength)
1042         result = handleLengthMethod(loc, function, arguments);
1043     else if (function->getBuiltInOp() != EOpNull) {
1044         //
1045         // Then this should be a constructor.
1046         // Don't go through the symbol table for constructors.
1047         // Their parameters will be verified algorithmically.
1048         //
1049         TType type(EbtVoid);  // use this to get the type back
1050         if (! constructorError(loc, arguments, *function, function->getBuiltInOp(), type)) {
1051             //
1052             // It's a constructor, of type 'type'.
1053             //
1054             result = addConstructor(loc, arguments, type);
1055             if (result == nullptr)
1056                 error(loc, "cannot construct with these arguments", type.getCompleteString().c_str(), "");
1057         }
1058     } else {
1059         //
1060         // Find it in the symbol table.
1061         //
1062         const TFunction* fnCandidate;
1063         bool builtIn;
1064         fnCandidate = findFunction(loc, *function, builtIn);
1065         if (fnCandidate) {
1066             // This is a declared function that might map to
1067             //  - a built-in operator,
1068             //  - a built-in function not mapped to an operator, or
1069             //  - a user function.
1070 
1071             // Error check for a function requiring specific extensions present.
1072             if (builtIn && fnCandidate->getNumExtensions())
1073                 requireExtensions(loc, fnCandidate->getNumExtensions(), fnCandidate->getExtensions(), fnCandidate->getName().c_str());
1074 
1075             if (builtIn && fnCandidate->getType().containsBasicType(EbtFloat16))
1076                 requireFloat16Arithmetic(loc, "built-in function", "float16 types can only be in uniform block or buffer storage");
1077             if (builtIn && fnCandidate->getType().contains16BitInt())
1078                 requireInt16Arithmetic(loc, "built-in function", "(u)int16 types can only be in uniform block or buffer storage");
1079             if (builtIn && fnCandidate->getType().contains8BitInt())
1080                 requireInt8Arithmetic(loc, "built-in function", "(u)int8 types can only be in uniform block or buffer storage");
1081 
1082             if (arguments != nullptr) {
1083                 // Make sure qualifications work for these arguments.
1084                 TIntermAggregate* aggregate = arguments->getAsAggregate();
1085                 for (int i = 0; i < fnCandidate->getParamCount(); ++i) {
1086                     // At this early point there is a slight ambiguity between whether an aggregate 'arguments'
1087                     // is the single argument itself or its children are the arguments.  Only one argument
1088                     // means take 'arguments' itself as the one argument.
1089                     TIntermNode* arg = fnCandidate->getParamCount() == 1 ? arguments : (aggregate ? aggregate->getSequence()[i] : arguments);
1090                     TQualifier& formalQualifier = (*fnCandidate)[i].type->getQualifier();
1091                     if (formalQualifier.isParamOutput()) {
1092                         if (lValueErrorCheck(arguments->getLoc(), "assign", arg->getAsTyped()))
1093                             error(arguments->getLoc(), "Non-L-value cannot be passed for 'out' or 'inout' parameters.", "out", "");
1094                     }
1095                     TQualifier& argQualifier = arg->getAsTyped()->getQualifier();
1096                     if (argQualifier.isMemory()) {
1097                         const char* message = "argument cannot drop memory qualifier when passed to formal parameter";
1098                         if (argQualifier.volatil && ! formalQualifier.volatil)
1099                             error(arguments->getLoc(), message, "volatile", "");
1100                         if (argQualifier.coherent && ! (formalQualifier.devicecoherent || formalQualifier.coherent))
1101                             error(arguments->getLoc(), message, "coherent", "");
1102                         if (argQualifier.devicecoherent && ! (formalQualifier.devicecoherent || formalQualifier.coherent))
1103                             error(arguments->getLoc(), message, "devicecoherent", "");
1104                         if (argQualifier.queuefamilycoherent && ! (formalQualifier.queuefamilycoherent || formalQualifier.devicecoherent || formalQualifier.coherent))
1105                             error(arguments->getLoc(), message, "queuefamilycoherent", "");
1106                         if (argQualifier.workgroupcoherent && ! (formalQualifier.workgroupcoherent || formalQualifier.queuefamilycoherent || formalQualifier.devicecoherent || formalQualifier.coherent))
1107                             error(arguments->getLoc(), message, "workgroupcoherent", "");
1108                         if (argQualifier.subgroupcoherent && ! (formalQualifier.subgroupcoherent || formalQualifier.workgroupcoherent || formalQualifier.queuefamilycoherent || formalQualifier.devicecoherent || formalQualifier.coherent))
1109                             error(arguments->getLoc(), message, "subgroupcoherent", "");
1110                         if (argQualifier.readonly && ! formalQualifier.readonly)
1111                             error(arguments->getLoc(), message, "readonly", "");
1112                         if (argQualifier.writeonly && ! formalQualifier.writeonly)
1113                             error(arguments->getLoc(), message, "writeonly", "");
1114                     }
1115 
1116                     if (builtIn && arg->getAsTyped()->getType().containsBasicType(EbtFloat16))
1117                         requireFloat16Arithmetic(arguments->getLoc(), "built-in function", "float16 types can only be in uniform block or buffer storage");
1118                     if (builtIn && arg->getAsTyped()->getType().contains16BitInt())
1119                         requireInt16Arithmetic(arguments->getLoc(), "built-in function", "(u)int16 types can only be in uniform block or buffer storage");
1120                     if (builtIn && arg->getAsTyped()->getType().contains8BitInt())
1121                         requireInt8Arithmetic(arguments->getLoc(), "built-in function", "(u)int8 types can only be in uniform block or buffer storage");
1122 
1123                     // TODO 4.5 functionality:  A shader will fail to compile
1124                     // if the value passed to the memargument of an atomic memory function does not correspond to a buffer or
1125                     // shared variable. It is acceptable to pass an element of an array or a single component of a vector to the
1126                     // memargument of an atomic memory function, as long as the underlying array or vector is a buffer or
1127                     // shared variable.
1128                 }
1129 
1130                 // Convert 'in' arguments
1131                 addInputArgumentConversions(*fnCandidate, arguments);  // arguments may be modified if it's just a single argument node
1132             }
1133 
1134             if (builtIn && fnCandidate->getBuiltInOp() != EOpNull) {
1135                 // A function call mapped to a built-in operation.
1136                 result = handleBuiltInFunctionCall(loc, arguments, *fnCandidate);
1137             } else {
1138                 // This is a function call not mapped to built-in operator.
1139                 // It could still be a built-in function, but only if PureOperatorBuiltins == false.
1140                 result = intermediate.setAggregateOperator(arguments, EOpFunctionCall, fnCandidate->getType(), loc);
1141                 TIntermAggregate* call = result->getAsAggregate();
1142                 call->setName(fnCandidate->getMangledName());
1143 
1144                 // this is how we know whether the given function is a built-in function or a user-defined function
1145                 // if builtIn == false, it's a userDefined -> could be an overloaded built-in function also
1146                 // if builtIn == true, it's definitely a built-in function with EOpNull
1147                 if (! builtIn) {
1148                     call->setUserDefined();
1149                     if (symbolTable.atGlobalLevel()) {
1150                         requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, "calling user function from global scope");
1151                         intermediate.addToCallGraph(infoSink, "main(", fnCandidate->getMangledName());
1152                     } else
1153                         intermediate.addToCallGraph(infoSink, currentCaller, fnCandidate->getMangledName());
1154                 }
1155 
1156                 if (builtIn)
1157                     nonOpBuiltInCheck(loc, *fnCandidate, *call);
1158                 else
1159                     userFunctionCallCheck(loc, *call);
1160             }
1161 
1162             // Convert 'out' arguments.  If it was a constant folded built-in, it won't be an aggregate anymore.
1163             // Built-ins with a single argument aren't called with an aggregate, but they also don't have an output.
1164             // Also, build the qualifier list for user function calls, which are always called with an aggregate.
1165             if (result->getAsAggregate()) {
1166                 TQualifierList& qualifierList = result->getAsAggregate()->getQualifierList();
1167                 for (int i = 0; i < fnCandidate->getParamCount(); ++i) {
1168                     TStorageQualifier qual = (*fnCandidate)[i].type->getQualifier().storage;
1169                     qualifierList.push_back(qual);
1170                 }
1171                 result = addOutputArgumentConversions(*fnCandidate, *result->getAsAggregate());
1172             }
1173         }
1174     }
1175 
1176     // generic error recovery
1177     // TODO: simplification: localize all the error recoveries that look like this, and taking type into account to reduce cascades
1178     if (result == nullptr)
1179         result = intermediate.addConstantUnion(0.0, EbtFloat, loc);
1180 
1181     return result;
1182 }
1183 
handleBuiltInFunctionCall(TSourceLoc loc,TIntermNode * arguments,const TFunction & function)1184 TIntermTyped* TParseContext::handleBuiltInFunctionCall(TSourceLoc loc, TIntermNode* arguments,
1185                                                        const TFunction& function)
1186 {
1187     checkLocation(loc, function.getBuiltInOp());
1188     TIntermTyped *result = intermediate.addBuiltInFunctionCall(loc, function.getBuiltInOp(),
1189                                                                function.getParamCount() == 1,
1190                                                                arguments, function.getType());
1191     if (obeyPrecisionQualifiers())
1192         computeBuiltinPrecisions(*result, function);
1193 
1194     if (result == nullptr) {
1195         if (arguments == nullptr)
1196             error(loc, " wrong operand type", "Internal Error",
1197                                       "built in unary operator function.  Type: %s", "");
1198         else
1199             error(arguments->getLoc(), " wrong operand type", "Internal Error",
1200                                       "built in unary operator function.  Type: %s",
1201                                       static_cast<TIntermTyped*>(arguments)->getCompleteString().c_str());
1202     } else if (result->getAsOperator())
1203         builtInOpCheck(loc, function, *result->getAsOperator());
1204 
1205     return result;
1206 }
1207 
1208 // "The operation of a built-in function can have a different precision
1209 // qualification than the precision qualification of the resulting value.
1210 // These two precision qualifications are established as follows.
1211 //
1212 // The precision qualification of the operation of a built-in function is
1213 // based on the precision qualification of its input arguments and formal
1214 // parameters:  When a formal parameter specifies a precision qualifier,
1215 // that is used, otherwise, the precision qualification of the calling
1216 // argument is used.  The highest precision of these will be the precision
1217 // qualification of the operation of the built-in function. Generally,
1218 // this is applied across all arguments to a built-in function, with the
1219 // exceptions being:
1220 //   - bitfieldExtract and bitfieldInsert ignore the 'offset' and 'bits'
1221 //     arguments.
1222 //   - interpolateAt* functions only look at the 'interpolant' argument.
1223 //
1224 // The precision qualification of the result of a built-in function is
1225 // determined in one of the following ways:
1226 //
1227 //   - For the texture sampling, image load, and image store functions,
1228 //     the precision of the return type matches the precision of the
1229 //     sampler type
1230 //
1231 //   Otherwise:
1232 //
1233 //   - For prototypes that do not specify a resulting precision qualifier,
1234 //     the precision will be the same as the precision of the operation.
1235 //
1236 //   - For prototypes that do specify a resulting precision qualifier,
1237 //     the specified precision qualifier is the precision qualification of
1238 //     the result."
1239 //
computeBuiltinPrecisions(TIntermTyped & node,const TFunction & function)1240 void TParseContext::computeBuiltinPrecisions(TIntermTyped& node, const TFunction& function)
1241 {
1242     TPrecisionQualifier operationPrecision = EpqNone;
1243     TPrecisionQualifier resultPrecision = EpqNone;
1244 
1245     TIntermOperator* opNode = node.getAsOperator();
1246     if (opNode == nullptr)
1247         return;
1248 
1249     if (TIntermUnary* unaryNode = node.getAsUnaryNode()) {
1250         operationPrecision = std::max(function[0].type->getQualifier().precision,
1251                                       unaryNode->getOperand()->getType().getQualifier().precision);
1252         if (function.getType().getBasicType() != EbtBool)
1253             resultPrecision = function.getType().getQualifier().precision == EpqNone ?
1254                                         operationPrecision :
1255                                         function.getType().getQualifier().precision;
1256     } else if (TIntermAggregate* agg = node.getAsAggregate()) {
1257         TIntermSequence& sequence = agg->getSequence();
1258         unsigned int numArgs = (unsigned int)sequence.size();
1259         switch (agg->getOp()) {
1260         case EOpBitfieldExtract:
1261             numArgs = 1;
1262             break;
1263         case EOpBitfieldInsert:
1264             numArgs = 2;
1265             break;
1266         case EOpInterpolateAtCentroid:
1267         case EOpInterpolateAtOffset:
1268         case EOpInterpolateAtSample:
1269             numArgs = 1;
1270             break;
1271         default:
1272             break;
1273         }
1274         // find the maximum precision from the arguments and parameters
1275         for (unsigned int arg = 0; arg < numArgs; ++arg) {
1276             operationPrecision = std::max(operationPrecision, sequence[arg]->getAsTyped()->getQualifier().precision);
1277             operationPrecision = std::max(operationPrecision, function[arg].type->getQualifier().precision);
1278         }
1279         // compute the result precision
1280 #ifdef AMD_EXTENSIONS
1281         if (agg->isSampling() ||
1282             agg->getOp() == EOpImageLoad || agg->getOp() == EOpImageStore ||
1283             agg->getOp() == EOpImageLoadLod || agg->getOp() == EOpImageStoreLod)
1284 #else
1285         if (agg->isSampling() || agg->getOp() == EOpImageLoad || agg->getOp() == EOpImageStore)
1286 #endif
1287             resultPrecision = sequence[0]->getAsTyped()->getQualifier().precision;
1288         else if (function.getType().getBasicType() != EbtBool)
1289             resultPrecision = function.getType().getQualifier().precision == EpqNone ?
1290                                         operationPrecision :
1291                                         function.getType().getQualifier().precision;
1292     }
1293 
1294     // Propagate precision through this node and its children. That algorithm stops
1295     // when a precision is found, so start by clearing this subroot precision
1296     opNode->getQualifier().precision = EpqNone;
1297     if (operationPrecision != EpqNone) {
1298         opNode->propagatePrecision(operationPrecision);
1299         opNode->setOperationPrecision(operationPrecision);
1300     }
1301     // Now, set the result precision, which might not match
1302     opNode->getQualifier().precision = resultPrecision;
1303 }
1304 
handleReturnValue(const TSourceLoc & loc,TIntermTyped * value)1305 TIntermNode* TParseContext::handleReturnValue(const TSourceLoc& loc, TIntermTyped* value)
1306 {
1307     storage16BitAssignmentCheck(loc, value->getType(), "return");
1308 
1309     functionReturnsValue = true;
1310     if (currentFunctionType->getBasicType() == EbtVoid) {
1311         error(loc, "void function cannot return a value", "return", "");
1312         return intermediate.addBranch(EOpReturn, loc);
1313     } else if (*currentFunctionType != value->getType()) {
1314         TIntermTyped* converted = intermediate.addConversion(EOpReturn, *currentFunctionType, value);
1315         if (converted) {
1316             if (*currentFunctionType != converted->getType())
1317                 error(loc, "cannot convert return value to function return type", "return", "");
1318             if (version < 420)
1319                 warn(loc, "type conversion on return values was not explicitly allowed until version 420", "return", "");
1320             return intermediate.addBranch(EOpReturn, converted, loc);
1321         } else {
1322             error(loc, "type does not match, or is not convertible to, the function's return type", "return", "");
1323             return intermediate.addBranch(EOpReturn, value, loc);
1324         }
1325     } else
1326         return intermediate.addBranch(EOpReturn, value, loc);
1327 }
1328 
1329 // See if the operation is being done in an illegal location.
checkLocation(const TSourceLoc & loc,TOperator op)1330 void TParseContext::checkLocation(const TSourceLoc& loc, TOperator op)
1331 {
1332     switch (op) {
1333     case EOpBarrier:
1334         if (language == EShLangTessControl) {
1335             if (controlFlowNestingLevel > 0)
1336                 error(loc, "tessellation control barrier() cannot be placed within flow control", "", "");
1337             if (! inMain)
1338                 error(loc, "tessellation control barrier() must be in main()", "", "");
1339             else if (postEntryPointReturn)
1340                 error(loc, "tessellation control barrier() cannot be placed after a return from main()", "", "");
1341         }
1342         break;
1343     default:
1344         break;
1345     }
1346 }
1347 
1348 // Finish processing object.length(). This started earlier in handleDotDereference(), where
1349 // the ".length" part was recognized and semantically checked, and finished here where the
1350 // function syntax "()" is recognized.
1351 //
1352 // Return resulting tree node.
handleLengthMethod(const TSourceLoc & loc,TFunction * function,TIntermNode * intermNode)1353 TIntermTyped* TParseContext::handleLengthMethod(const TSourceLoc& loc, TFunction* function, TIntermNode* intermNode)
1354 {
1355     int length = 0;
1356 
1357     if (function->getParamCount() > 0)
1358         error(loc, "method does not accept any arguments", function->getName().c_str(), "");
1359     else {
1360         const TType& type = intermNode->getAsTyped()->getType();
1361         if (type.isArray()) {
1362             if (type.isUnsizedArray()) {
1363                 if (intermNode->getAsSymbolNode() && isIoResizeArray(type)) {
1364                     // We could be between a layout declaration that gives a built-in io array implicit size and
1365                     // a user redeclaration of that array, meaning we have to substitute its implicit size here
1366                     // without actually redeclaring the array.  (It is an error to use a member before the
1367                     // redeclaration, but not an error to use the array name itself.)
1368                     const TString& name = intermNode->getAsSymbolNode()->getName();
1369                     if (name == "gl_in" || name == "gl_out"
1370 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
1371                         || name == "gl_MeshVerticesNV"
1372                         || name == "gl_MeshPrimitivesNV"
1373 #endif
1374                         )
1375                     {
1376                         length = getIoArrayImplicitSize(type.getQualifier().isPerPrimitive());
1377                     }
1378                 }
1379                 if (length == 0) {
1380                     if (intermNode->getAsSymbolNode() && isIoResizeArray(type))
1381                         error(loc, "", function->getName().c_str(), "array must first be sized by a redeclaration or layout qualifier");
1382                     else if (isRuntimeLength(*intermNode->getAsTyped())) {
1383                         // Create a unary op and let the back end handle it
1384                         return intermediate.addBuiltInFunctionCall(loc, EOpArrayLength, true, intermNode, TType(EbtInt));
1385                     } else
1386                         error(loc, "", function->getName().c_str(), "array must be declared with a size before using this method");
1387                 }
1388             } else if (type.getOuterArrayNode()) {
1389                 // If the array's outer size is specified by an intermediate node, it means the array's length
1390                 // was specified by a specialization constant. In such a case, we should return the node of the
1391                 // specialization constants to represent the length.
1392                 return type.getOuterArrayNode();
1393             } else
1394                 length = type.getOuterArraySize();
1395         } else if (type.isMatrix())
1396             length = type.getMatrixCols();
1397         else if (type.isVector())
1398             length = type.getVectorSize();
1399         else {
1400             // we should not get here, because earlier semantic checking should have prevented this path
1401             error(loc, ".length()", "unexpected use of .length()", "");
1402         }
1403     }
1404 
1405     if (length == 0)
1406         length = 1;
1407 
1408     return intermediate.addConstantUnion(length, loc);
1409 }
1410 
1411 //
1412 // Add any needed implicit conversions for function-call arguments to input parameters.
1413 //
addInputArgumentConversions(const TFunction & function,TIntermNode * & arguments) const1414 void TParseContext::addInputArgumentConversions(const TFunction& function, TIntermNode*& arguments) const
1415 {
1416     TIntermAggregate* aggregate = arguments->getAsAggregate();
1417 
1418     // Process each argument's conversion
1419     for (int i = 0; i < function.getParamCount(); ++i) {
1420         // At this early point there is a slight ambiguity between whether an aggregate 'arguments'
1421         // is the single argument itself or its children are the arguments.  Only one argument
1422         // means take 'arguments' itself as the one argument.
1423         TIntermTyped* arg = function.getParamCount() == 1 ? arguments->getAsTyped() : (aggregate ? aggregate->getSequence()[i]->getAsTyped() : arguments->getAsTyped());
1424         if (*function[i].type != arg->getType()) {
1425             if (function[i].type->getQualifier().isParamInput()) {
1426                 // In-qualified arguments just need an extra node added above the argument to
1427                 // convert to the correct type.
1428                 arg = intermediate.addConversion(EOpFunctionCall, *function[i].type, arg);
1429                 if (arg) {
1430                     if (function.getParamCount() == 1)
1431                         arguments = arg;
1432                     else {
1433                         if (aggregate)
1434                             aggregate->getSequence()[i] = arg;
1435                         else
1436                             arguments = arg;
1437                     }
1438                 }
1439             }
1440         }
1441     }
1442 }
1443 
1444 //
1445 // Add any needed implicit output conversions for function-call arguments.  This
1446 // can require a new tree topology, complicated further by whether the function
1447 // has a return value.
1448 //
1449 // Returns a node of a subtree that evaluates to the return value of the function.
1450 //
addOutputArgumentConversions(const TFunction & function,TIntermAggregate & intermNode) const1451 TIntermTyped* TParseContext::addOutputArgumentConversions(const TFunction& function, TIntermAggregate& intermNode) const
1452 {
1453     TIntermSequence& arguments = intermNode.getSequence();
1454 
1455     // Will there be any output conversions?
1456     bool outputConversions = false;
1457     for (int i = 0; i < function.getParamCount(); ++i) {
1458         if (*function[i].type != arguments[i]->getAsTyped()->getType() && function[i].type->getQualifier().isParamOutput()) {
1459             outputConversions = true;
1460             break;
1461         }
1462     }
1463 
1464     if (! outputConversions)
1465         return &intermNode;
1466 
1467     // Setup for the new tree, if needed:
1468     //
1469     // Output conversions need a different tree topology.
1470     // Out-qualified arguments need a temporary of the correct type, with the call
1471     // followed by an assignment of the temporary to the original argument:
1472     //     void: function(arg, ...)  ->        (          function(tempArg, ...), arg = tempArg, ...)
1473     //     ret = function(arg, ...)  ->  ret = (tempRet = function(tempArg, ...), arg = tempArg, ..., tempRet)
1474     // Where the "tempArg" type needs no conversion as an argument, but will convert on assignment.
1475     TIntermTyped* conversionTree = nullptr;
1476     TVariable* tempRet = nullptr;
1477     if (intermNode.getBasicType() != EbtVoid) {
1478         // do the "tempRet = function(...), " bit from above
1479         tempRet = makeInternalVariable("tempReturn", intermNode.getType());
1480         TIntermSymbol* tempRetNode = intermediate.addSymbol(*tempRet, intermNode.getLoc());
1481         conversionTree = intermediate.addAssign(EOpAssign, tempRetNode, &intermNode, intermNode.getLoc());
1482     } else
1483         conversionTree = &intermNode;
1484 
1485     conversionTree = intermediate.makeAggregate(conversionTree);
1486 
1487     // Process each argument's conversion
1488     for (int i = 0; i < function.getParamCount(); ++i) {
1489         if (*function[i].type != arguments[i]->getAsTyped()->getType()) {
1490             if (function[i].type->getQualifier().isParamOutput()) {
1491                 // Out-qualified arguments need to use the topology set up above.
1492                 // do the " ...(tempArg, ...), arg = tempArg" bit from above
1493                 TVariable* tempArg = makeInternalVariable("tempArg", *function[i].type);
1494                 tempArg->getWritableType().getQualifier().makeTemporary();
1495                 TIntermSymbol* tempArgNode = intermediate.addSymbol(*tempArg, intermNode.getLoc());
1496                 TIntermTyped* tempAssign = intermediate.addAssign(EOpAssign, arguments[i]->getAsTyped(), tempArgNode, arguments[i]->getLoc());
1497                 conversionTree = intermediate.growAggregate(conversionTree, tempAssign, arguments[i]->getLoc());
1498                 // replace the argument with another node for the same tempArg variable
1499                 arguments[i] = intermediate.addSymbol(*tempArg, intermNode.getLoc());
1500             }
1501         }
1502     }
1503 
1504     // Finalize the tree topology (see bigger comment above).
1505     if (tempRet) {
1506         // do the "..., tempRet" bit from above
1507         TIntermSymbol* tempRetNode = intermediate.addSymbol(*tempRet, intermNode.getLoc());
1508         conversionTree = intermediate.growAggregate(conversionTree, tempRetNode, intermNode.getLoc());
1509     }
1510     conversionTree = intermediate.setAggregateOperator(conversionTree, EOpComma, intermNode.getType(), intermNode.getLoc());
1511 
1512     return conversionTree;
1513 }
1514 
memorySemanticsCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TFunction & fnCandidate,const TIntermOperator & callNode)1515 void TParseContext::memorySemanticsCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TFunction& fnCandidate, const TIntermOperator& callNode)
1516 {
1517     const TIntermSequence* argp = &callNode.getAsAggregate()->getSequence();
1518 
1519     //const int gl_SemanticsRelaxed         = 0x0;
1520     const int gl_SemanticsAcquire         = 0x2;
1521     const int gl_SemanticsRelease         = 0x4;
1522     const int gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease  = 0x8;
1523     const int gl_SemanticsMakeAvailable   = 0x2000;
1524     const int gl_SemanticsMakeVisible     = 0x4000;
1525 
1526     //const int gl_StorageSemanticsNone     = 0x0;
1527     const int gl_StorageSemanticsBuffer   = 0x40;
1528     const int gl_StorageSemanticsShared   = 0x100;
1529     const int gl_StorageSemanticsImage    = 0x800;
1530     const int gl_StorageSemanticsOutput   = 0x1000;
1531 
1532 
1533     unsigned int semantics = 0, storageClassSemantics = 0;
1534     unsigned int semantics2 = 0, storageClassSemantics2 = 0;
1535 
1536     // Grab the semantics and storage class semantics from the operands, based on opcode
1537     switch (callNode.getOp()) {
1538     case EOpAtomicAdd:
1539     case EOpAtomicMin:
1540     case EOpAtomicMax:
1541     case EOpAtomicAnd:
1542     case EOpAtomicOr:
1543     case EOpAtomicXor:
1544     case EOpAtomicExchange:
1545     case EOpAtomicStore:
1546         storageClassSemantics = (*argp)[3]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1547         semantics = (*argp)[4]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1548         break;
1549     case EOpAtomicLoad:
1550         storageClassSemantics = (*argp)[2]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1551         semantics = (*argp)[3]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1552         break;
1553     case EOpAtomicCompSwap:
1554         storageClassSemantics = (*argp)[4]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1555         semantics = (*argp)[5]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1556         storageClassSemantics2 = (*argp)[6]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1557         semantics2 = (*argp)[7]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1558         break;
1559 
1560     case EOpImageAtomicAdd:
1561     case EOpImageAtomicMin:
1562     case EOpImageAtomicMax:
1563     case EOpImageAtomicAnd:
1564     case EOpImageAtomicOr:
1565     case EOpImageAtomicXor:
1566     case EOpImageAtomicExchange:
1567     case EOpImageAtomicStore:
1568         storageClassSemantics = (*argp)[4]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1569         semantics = (*argp)[5]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1570         break;
1571     case EOpImageAtomicLoad:
1572         storageClassSemantics = (*argp)[3]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1573         semantics = (*argp)[4]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1574         break;
1575     case EOpImageAtomicCompSwap:
1576         storageClassSemantics = (*argp)[5]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1577         semantics = (*argp)[6]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1578         storageClassSemantics2 = (*argp)[7]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1579         semantics2 = (*argp)[8]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1580         break;
1581 
1582     case EOpBarrier:
1583         storageClassSemantics = (*argp)[2]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1584         semantics = (*argp)[3]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1585         break;
1586     case EOpMemoryBarrier:
1587         storageClassSemantics = (*argp)[1]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1588         semantics = (*argp)[2]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1589         break;
1590     default:
1591         break;
1592     }
1593 
1594     if ((semantics & gl_SemanticsAcquire) &&
1595         (callNode.getOp() == EOpAtomicStore || callNode.getOp() == EOpImageAtomicStore)) {
1596         error(loc, "gl_SemanticsAcquire must not be used with (image) atomic store",
1597               fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
1598     }
1599     if ((semantics & gl_SemanticsRelease) &&
1600         (callNode.getOp() == EOpAtomicLoad || callNode.getOp() == EOpImageAtomicLoad)) {
1601         error(loc, "gl_SemanticsRelease must not be used with (image) atomic load",
1602               fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
1603     }
1604     if ((semantics & gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease) &&
1605         (callNode.getOp() == EOpAtomicStore || callNode.getOp() == EOpImageAtomicStore ||
1606          callNode.getOp() == EOpAtomicLoad  || callNode.getOp() == EOpImageAtomicLoad)) {
1607         error(loc, "gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease must not be used with (image) atomic load/store",
1608               fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
1609     }
1610     if (((semantics | semantics2) & ~(gl_SemanticsAcquire |
1611                                       gl_SemanticsRelease |
1612                                       gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease |
1613                                       gl_SemanticsMakeAvailable |
1614                                       gl_SemanticsMakeVisible))) {
1615         error(loc, "Invalid semantics value", fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
1616     }
1617     if (((storageClassSemantics | storageClassSemantics2) & ~(gl_StorageSemanticsBuffer |
1618                                                               gl_StorageSemanticsShared |
1619                                                               gl_StorageSemanticsImage |
1620                                                               gl_StorageSemanticsOutput))) {
1621         error(loc, "Invalid storage class semantics value", fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
1622     }
1623 
1624     if (callNode.getOp() == EOpMemoryBarrier) {
1625         if (!IsPow2(semantics & (gl_SemanticsAcquire | gl_SemanticsRelease | gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease))) {
1626             error(loc, "Semantics must include exactly one of gl_SemanticsRelease, gl_SemanticsAcquire, or "
1627                        "gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease", fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
1628         }
1629     } else {
1630         if (semantics & (gl_SemanticsAcquire | gl_SemanticsRelease | gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease)) {
1631             if (!IsPow2(semantics & (gl_SemanticsAcquire | gl_SemanticsRelease | gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease))) {
1632                 error(loc, "Semantics must not include multiple of gl_SemanticsRelease, gl_SemanticsAcquire, or "
1633                            "gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease", fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
1634             }
1635         }
1636         if (semantics2 & (gl_SemanticsAcquire | gl_SemanticsRelease | gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease)) {
1637             if (!IsPow2(semantics2 & (gl_SemanticsAcquire | gl_SemanticsRelease | gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease))) {
1638                 error(loc, "semUnequal must not include multiple of gl_SemanticsRelease, gl_SemanticsAcquire, or "
1639                            "gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease", fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
1640             }
1641         }
1642     }
1643     if (callNode.getOp() == EOpMemoryBarrier) {
1644         if (storageClassSemantics == 0) {
1645             error(loc, "Storage class semantics must not be zero", fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
1646         }
1647     }
1648     if (callNode.getOp() == EOpBarrier && semantics != 0 && storageClassSemantics == 0) {
1649         error(loc, "Storage class semantics must not be zero", fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
1650     }
1651     if ((callNode.getOp() == EOpAtomicCompSwap || callNode.getOp() == EOpImageAtomicCompSwap) &&
1652         (semantics2 & (gl_SemanticsRelease | gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease))) {
1653         error(loc, "semUnequal must not be gl_SemanticsRelease or gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease",
1654               fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
1655     }
1656     if ((semantics & gl_SemanticsMakeAvailable) &&
1657         !(semantics & (gl_SemanticsRelease | gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease))) {
1658         error(loc, "gl_SemanticsMakeAvailable requires gl_SemanticsRelease or gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease",
1659               fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
1660     }
1661     if ((semantics & gl_SemanticsMakeVisible) &&
1662         !(semantics & (gl_SemanticsAcquire | gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease))) {
1663         error(loc, "gl_SemanticsMakeVisible requires gl_SemanticsAcquire or gl_SemanticsAcquireRelease",
1664               fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
1665     }
1666 
1667 }
1668 
1669 
1670 //
1671 // Do additional checking of built-in function calls that is not caught
1672 // by normal semantic checks on argument type, extension tagging, etc.
1673 //
1674 // Assumes there has been a semantically correct match to a built-in function prototype.
1675 //
builtInOpCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TFunction & fnCandidate,TIntermOperator & callNode)1676 void TParseContext::builtInOpCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TFunction& fnCandidate, TIntermOperator& callNode)
1677 {
1678     // Set up convenience accessors to the argument(s).  There is almost always
1679     // multiple arguments for the cases below, but when there might be one,
1680     // check the unaryArg first.
1681     const TIntermSequence* argp = nullptr;   // confusing to use [] syntax on a pointer, so this is to help get a reference
1682     const TIntermTyped* unaryArg = nullptr;
1683     const TIntermTyped* arg0 = nullptr;
1684     if (callNode.getAsAggregate()) {
1685         argp = &callNode.getAsAggregate()->getSequence();
1686         if (argp->size() > 0)
1687             arg0 = (*argp)[0]->getAsTyped();
1688     } else {
1689         assert(callNode.getAsUnaryNode());
1690         unaryArg = callNode.getAsUnaryNode()->getOperand();
1691         arg0 = unaryArg;
1692     }
1693 
1694     TString featureString;
1695     const char* feature = nullptr;
1696     switch (callNode.getOp()) {
1697     case EOpTextureGather:
1698     case EOpTextureGatherOffset:
1699     case EOpTextureGatherOffsets:
1700     {
1701         // Figure out which variants are allowed by what extensions,
1702         // and what arguments must be constant for which situations.
1703 
1704         featureString = fnCandidate.getName();
1705         featureString += "(...)";
1706         feature = featureString.c_str();
1707         profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 310, nullptr, feature);
1708         int compArg = -1;  // track which argument, if any, is the constant component argument
1709         switch (callNode.getOp()) {
1710         case EOpTextureGather:
1711             // More than two arguments needs gpu_shader5, and rectangular or shadow needs gpu_shader5,
1712             // otherwise, need GL_ARB_texture_gather.
1713             if (fnCandidate.getParamCount() > 2 || fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().dim == EsdRect || fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().shadow) {
1714                 profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 400, E_GL_ARB_gpu_shader5, feature);
1715                 if (! fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().shadow)
1716                     compArg = 2;
1717             } else
1718                 profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 400, E_GL_ARB_texture_gather, feature);
1719             break;
1720         case EOpTextureGatherOffset:
1721             // GL_ARB_texture_gather is good enough for 2D non-shadow textures with no component argument
1722             if (fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().dim == Esd2D && ! fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().shadow && fnCandidate.getParamCount() == 3)
1723                 profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 400, E_GL_ARB_texture_gather, feature);
1724             else
1725                 profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 400, E_GL_ARB_gpu_shader5, feature);
1726             if (! (*argp)[fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().shadow ? 3 : 2]->getAsConstantUnion())
1727                 profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 320, Num_AEP_gpu_shader5, AEP_gpu_shader5,
1728                                 "non-constant offset argument");
1729             if (! fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().shadow)
1730                 compArg = 3;
1731             break;
1732         case EOpTextureGatherOffsets:
1733             profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 400, E_GL_ARB_gpu_shader5, feature);
1734             if (! fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().shadow)
1735                 compArg = 3;
1736             // check for constant offsets
1737             if (! (*argp)[fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().shadow ? 3 : 2]->getAsConstantUnion())
1738                 error(loc, "must be a compile-time constant:", feature, "offsets argument");
1739             break;
1740         default:
1741             break;
1742         }
1743 
1744         if (compArg > 0 && compArg < fnCandidate.getParamCount()) {
1745             if ((*argp)[compArg]->getAsConstantUnion()) {
1746                 int value = (*argp)[compArg]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
1747                 if (value < 0 || value > 3)
1748                     error(loc, "must be 0, 1, 2, or 3:", feature, "component argument");
1749             } else
1750                 error(loc, "must be a compile-time constant:", feature, "component argument");
1751         }
1752 
1753 #ifdef AMD_EXTENSIONS
1754         bool bias = false;
1755         if (callNode.getOp() == EOpTextureGather)
1756             bias = fnCandidate.getParamCount() > 3;
1757         else if (callNode.getOp() == EOpTextureGatherOffset ||
1758                  callNode.getOp() == EOpTextureGatherOffsets)
1759             bias = fnCandidate.getParamCount() > 4;
1760 
1761         if (bias) {
1762             featureString = fnCandidate.getName();
1763             featureString += "with bias argument";
1764             feature = featureString.c_str();
1765             profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 450, nullptr, feature);
1766             requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_AMD_texture_gather_bias_lod, feature);
1767         }
1768 #endif
1769 
1770         break;
1771     }
1772 
1773 #ifdef AMD_EXTENSIONS
1774     case EOpSparseTextureGather:
1775     case EOpSparseTextureGatherOffset:
1776     case EOpSparseTextureGatherOffsets:
1777     {
1778         bool bias = false;
1779         if (callNode.getOp() == EOpSparseTextureGather)
1780             bias = fnCandidate.getParamCount() > 4;
1781         else if (callNode.getOp() == EOpSparseTextureGatherOffset ||
1782                  callNode.getOp() == EOpSparseTextureGatherOffsets)
1783             bias = fnCandidate.getParamCount() > 5;
1784 
1785         if (bias) {
1786             featureString = fnCandidate.getName();
1787             featureString += "with bias argument";
1788             feature = featureString.c_str();
1789             profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 450, nullptr, feature);
1790             requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_AMD_texture_gather_bias_lod, feature);
1791         }
1792 
1793         break;
1794     }
1795 
1796     case EOpSparseTextureGatherLod:
1797     case EOpSparseTextureGatherLodOffset:
1798     case EOpSparseTextureGatherLodOffsets:
1799     {
1800         requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_ARB_sparse_texture2, fnCandidate.getName().c_str());
1801         break;
1802     }
1803 
1804     case EOpSwizzleInvocations:
1805     {
1806         if (! (*argp)[1]->getAsConstantUnion())
1807             error(loc, "argument must be compile-time constant", "offset", "");
1808         else {
1809             unsigned offset[4] = {};
1810             offset[0] = (*argp)[1]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getUConst();
1811             offset[1] = (*argp)[1]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[1].getUConst();
1812             offset[2] = (*argp)[1]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[2].getUConst();
1813             offset[3] = (*argp)[1]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[3].getUConst();
1814             if (offset[0] > 3 || offset[1] > 3 || offset[2] > 3 || offset[3] > 3)
1815                 error(loc, "components must be in the range [0, 3]", "offset", "");
1816         }
1817 
1818         break;
1819     }
1820 
1821     case EOpSwizzleInvocationsMasked:
1822     {
1823         if (! (*argp)[1]->getAsConstantUnion())
1824             error(loc, "argument must be compile-time constant", "mask", "");
1825         else {
1826             unsigned mask[3] = {};
1827             mask[0] = (*argp)[1]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getUConst();
1828             mask[1] = (*argp)[1]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[1].getUConst();
1829             mask[2] = (*argp)[1]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[2].getUConst();
1830             if (mask[0] > 31 || mask[1] > 31 || mask[2] > 31)
1831                 error(loc, "components must be in the range [0, 31]", "mask", "");
1832         }
1833 
1834         break;
1835     }
1836 #endif
1837 
1838     case EOpTextureOffset:
1839     case EOpTextureFetchOffset:
1840     case EOpTextureProjOffset:
1841     case EOpTextureLodOffset:
1842     case EOpTextureProjLodOffset:
1843     case EOpTextureGradOffset:
1844     case EOpTextureProjGradOffset:
1845     {
1846         // Handle texture-offset limits checking
1847         // Pick which argument has to hold constant offsets
1848         int arg = -1;
1849         switch (callNode.getOp()) {
1850         case EOpTextureOffset:          arg = 2;  break;
1851         case EOpTextureFetchOffset:     arg = (arg0->getType().getSampler().dim != EsdRect) ? 3 : 2; break;
1852         case EOpTextureProjOffset:      arg = 2;  break;
1853         case EOpTextureLodOffset:       arg = 3;  break;
1854         case EOpTextureProjLodOffset:   arg = 3;  break;
1855         case EOpTextureGradOffset:      arg = 4;  break;
1856         case EOpTextureProjGradOffset:  arg = 4;  break;
1857         default:
1858             assert(0);
1859             break;
1860         }
1861 
1862         if (arg > 0) {
1863 
1864 #ifdef AMD_EXTENSIONS
1865             bool f16ShadowCompare = (*argp)[1]->getAsTyped()->getBasicType() == EbtFloat16 && arg0->getType().getSampler().shadow;
1866             if (f16ShadowCompare)
1867                 ++arg;
1868 #endif
1869             if (! (*argp)[arg]->getAsConstantUnion())
1870                 error(loc, "argument must be compile-time constant", "texel offset", "");
1871             else {
1872                 const TType& type = (*argp)[arg]->getAsTyped()->getType();
1873                 for (int c = 0; c < type.getVectorSize(); ++c) {
1874                     int offset = (*argp)[arg]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[c].getIConst();
1875                     if (offset > resources.maxProgramTexelOffset || offset < resources.minProgramTexelOffset)
1876                         error(loc, "value is out of range:", "texel offset", "[gl_MinProgramTexelOffset, gl_MaxProgramTexelOffset]");
1877                 }
1878             }
1879         }
1880 
1881         break;
1882     }
1883 
1884 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
1885     case EOpTraceNV:
1886         if (!(*argp)[10]->getAsConstantUnion())
1887             error(loc, "argument must be compile-time constant", "payload number", "");
1888         break;
1889     case EOpExecuteCallableNV:
1890         if (!(*argp)[1]->getAsConstantUnion())
1891             error(loc, "argument must be compile-time constant", "callable data number", "");
1892         break;
1893 #endif
1894 
1895     case EOpTextureQuerySamples:
1896     case EOpImageQuerySamples:
1897         // GL_ARB_shader_texture_image_samples
1898         profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 450, E_GL_ARB_shader_texture_image_samples, "textureSamples and imageSamples");
1899         break;
1900 
1901     case EOpImageAtomicAdd:
1902     case EOpImageAtomicMin:
1903     case EOpImageAtomicMax:
1904     case EOpImageAtomicAnd:
1905     case EOpImageAtomicOr:
1906     case EOpImageAtomicXor:
1907     case EOpImageAtomicExchange:
1908     case EOpImageAtomicCompSwap:
1909     case EOpImageAtomicLoad:
1910     case EOpImageAtomicStore:
1911     {
1912         // Make sure the image types have the correct layout() format and correct argument types
1913         const TType& imageType = arg0->getType();
1914         if (imageType.getSampler().type == EbtInt || imageType.getSampler().type == EbtUint) {
1915             if (imageType.getQualifier().layoutFormat != ElfR32i && imageType.getQualifier().layoutFormat != ElfR32ui)
1916                 error(loc, "only supported on image with format r32i or r32ui", fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
1917         } else {
1918             if (fnCandidate.getName().compare(0, 19, "imageAtomicExchange") != 0)
1919                 error(loc, "only supported on integer images", fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
1920             else if (imageType.getQualifier().layoutFormat != ElfR32f && profile == EEsProfile)
1921                 error(loc, "only supported on image with format r32f", fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
1922         }
1923 
1924         const size_t maxArgs = imageType.getSampler().isMultiSample() ? 5 : 4;
1925         if (argp->size() > maxArgs) {
1926             requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_KHR_memory_scope_semantics, fnCandidate.getName().c_str());
1927             memorySemanticsCheck(loc, fnCandidate, callNode);
1928         }
1929 
1930         break;
1931     }
1932 
1933     case EOpAtomicAdd:
1934     case EOpAtomicMin:
1935     case EOpAtomicMax:
1936     case EOpAtomicAnd:
1937     case EOpAtomicOr:
1938     case EOpAtomicXor:
1939     case EOpAtomicExchange:
1940     case EOpAtomicCompSwap:
1941     case EOpAtomicLoad:
1942     case EOpAtomicStore:
1943     {
1944         if (argp->size() > 3) {
1945             requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_KHR_memory_scope_semantics, fnCandidate.getName().c_str());
1946             memorySemanticsCheck(loc, fnCandidate, callNode);
1947         } else if (arg0->getType().getBasicType() == EbtInt64 || arg0->getType().getBasicType() == EbtUint64) {
1948 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
1949             const char* const extensions[2] = { E_GL_NV_shader_atomic_int64,
1950                                                 E_GL_EXT_shader_atomic_int64 };
1951             requireExtensions(loc, 2, extensions, fnCandidate.getName().c_str());
1952 #else
1953             requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_EXT_shader_atomic_int64, fnCandidate.getName().c_str());
1954 #endif
1955         }
1956         break;
1957     }
1958 
1959     case EOpInterpolateAtCentroid:
1960     case EOpInterpolateAtSample:
1961     case EOpInterpolateAtOffset:
1962 #ifdef AMD_EXTENSIONS
1963     case EOpInterpolateAtVertex:
1964 #endif
1965         // Make sure the first argument is an interpolant, or an array element of an interpolant
1966         if (arg0->getType().getQualifier().storage != EvqVaryingIn) {
1967             // It might still be an array element.
1968             //
1969             // We could check more, but the semantics of the first argument are already met; the
1970             // only way to turn an array into a float/vec* is array dereference and swizzle.
1971             //
1972             // ES and desktop 4.3 and earlier:  swizzles may not be used
1973             // desktop 4.4 and later: swizzles may be used
1974             bool swizzleOkay = (profile != EEsProfile) && (version >= 440);
1975             const TIntermTyped* base = TIntermediate::findLValueBase(arg0, swizzleOkay);
1976             if (base == nullptr || base->getType().getQualifier().storage != EvqVaryingIn)
1977                 error(loc, "first argument must be an interpolant, or interpolant-array element", fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
1978         }
1979 
1980 #ifdef AMD_EXTENSIONS
1981         if (callNode.getOp() == EOpInterpolateAtVertex) {
1982             if (!arg0->getType().getQualifier().isExplicitInterpolation())
1983                 error(loc, "argument must be qualified as __explicitInterpAMD in", "interpolant", "");
1984             else {
1985                 if (! (*argp)[1]->getAsConstantUnion())
1986                     error(loc, "argument must be compile-time constant", "vertex index", "");
1987                 else {
1988                     unsigned vertexIdx = (*argp)[1]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getUConst();
1989                     if (vertexIdx > 2)
1990                         error(loc, "must be in the range [0, 2]", "vertex index", "");
1991                 }
1992             }
1993         }
1994 #endif
1995 
1996         break;
1997 
1998     case EOpEmitStreamVertex:
1999     case EOpEndStreamPrimitive:
2000         intermediate.setMultiStream();
2001         break;
2002 
2003     case EOpSubgroupClusteredAdd:
2004     case EOpSubgroupClusteredMul:
2005     case EOpSubgroupClusteredMin:
2006     case EOpSubgroupClusteredMax:
2007     case EOpSubgroupClusteredAnd:
2008     case EOpSubgroupClusteredOr:
2009     case EOpSubgroupClusteredXor:
2010         // The <clusterSize> as used in the subgroupClustered<op>() operations must be:
2011         // - An integral constant expression.
2012         // - At least 1.
2013         // - A power of 2.
2014         if ((*argp)[1]->getAsConstantUnion() == nullptr)
2015             error(loc, "argument must be compile-time constant", "cluster size", "");
2016         else {
2017             int size = (*argp)[1]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
2018             if (size < 1)
2019                 error(loc, "argument must be at least 1", "cluster size", "");
2020             else if (!IsPow2(size))
2021                 error(loc, "argument must be a power of 2", "cluster size", "");
2022         }
2023         break;
2024 
2025     case EOpSubgroupBroadcast:
2026         // <id> must be an integral constant expression.
2027         if ((*argp)[1]->getAsConstantUnion() == nullptr)
2028             error(loc, "argument must be compile-time constant", "id", "");
2029         break;
2030 
2031     case EOpBarrier:
2032     case EOpMemoryBarrier:
2033         if (argp->size() > 0) {
2034             requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_KHR_memory_scope_semantics, fnCandidate.getName().c_str());
2035             memorySemanticsCheck(loc, fnCandidate, callNode);
2036         }
2037         break;
2038 
2039     default:
2040         break;
2041     }
2042 
2043     // Texture operations on texture objects (aside from texelFetch on a
2044     // textureBuffer) require EXT_samplerless_texture_functions.
2045     switch (callNode.getOp()) {
2046     case EOpTextureQuerySize:
2047     case EOpTextureQueryLevels:
2048     case EOpTextureQuerySamples:
2049     case EOpTextureFetch:
2050     case EOpTextureFetchOffset:
2051     {
2052         const TSampler& sampler = fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler();
2053 
2054         const bool isTexture = sampler.isTexture() && !sampler.isCombined();
2055         const bool isBuffer = sampler.dim == EsdBuffer;
2056         const bool isFetch = callNode.getOp() == EOpTextureFetch || callNode.getOp() == EOpTextureFetchOffset;
2057 
2058         if (isTexture && (!isBuffer || !isFetch))
2059             requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_EXT_samplerless_texture_functions, fnCandidate.getName().c_str());
2060 
2061         break;
2062     }
2063 
2064     default:
2065         break;
2066     }
2067 
2068     if (callNode.getOp() > EOpSubgroupGuardStart && callNode.getOp() < EOpSubgroupGuardStop) {
2069         // these require SPIR-V 1.3
2070         if (spvVersion.spv > 0 && spvVersion.spv < EShTargetSpv_1_3)
2071             error(loc, "requires SPIR-V 1.3", "subgroup op", "");
2072     }
2073 }
2074 
2075 extern bool PureOperatorBuiltins;
2076 
2077 // Deprecated!  Use PureOperatorBuiltins == true instead, in which case this
2078 // functionality is handled in builtInOpCheck() instead of here.
2079 //
2080 // Do additional checking of built-in function calls that were not mapped
2081 // to built-in operations (e.g., texturing functions).
2082 //
2083 // Assumes there has been a semantically correct match to a built-in function.
2084 //
nonOpBuiltInCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TFunction & fnCandidate,TIntermAggregate & callNode)2085 void TParseContext::nonOpBuiltInCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TFunction& fnCandidate, TIntermAggregate& callNode)
2086 {
2087     // Further maintenance of this function is deprecated, because the "correct"
2088     // future-oriented design is to not have to do string compares on function names.
2089 
2090     // If PureOperatorBuiltins == true, then all built-ins should be mapped
2091     // to a TOperator, and this function would then never get called.
2092 
2093     assert(PureOperatorBuiltins == false);
2094 
2095     // built-in texturing functions get their return value precision from the precision of the sampler
2096     if (fnCandidate.getType().getQualifier().precision == EpqNone &&
2097         fnCandidate.getParamCount() > 0 && fnCandidate[0].type->getBasicType() == EbtSampler)
2098         callNode.getQualifier().precision = callNode.getSequence()[0]->getAsTyped()->getQualifier().precision;
2099 
2100     if (fnCandidate.getName().compare(0, 7, "texture") == 0) {
2101         if (fnCandidate.getName().compare(0, 13, "textureGather") == 0) {
2102             TString featureString = fnCandidate.getName() + "(...)";
2103             const char* feature = featureString.c_str();
2104             profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 310, nullptr, feature);
2105 
2106             int compArg = -1;  // track which argument, if any, is the constant component argument
2107             if (fnCandidate.getName().compare("textureGatherOffset") == 0) {
2108                 // GL_ARB_texture_gather is good enough for 2D non-shadow textures with no component argument
2109                 if (fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().dim == Esd2D && ! fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().shadow && fnCandidate.getParamCount() == 3)
2110                     profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 400, E_GL_ARB_texture_gather, feature);
2111                 else
2112                     profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 400, E_GL_ARB_gpu_shader5, feature);
2113                 int offsetArg = fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().shadow ? 3 : 2;
2114                 if (! callNode.getSequence()[offsetArg]->getAsConstantUnion())
2115                     profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 320, Num_AEP_gpu_shader5, AEP_gpu_shader5,
2116                                     "non-constant offset argument");
2117                 if (! fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().shadow)
2118                     compArg = 3;
2119             } else if (fnCandidate.getName().compare("textureGatherOffsets") == 0) {
2120                 profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 400, E_GL_ARB_gpu_shader5, feature);
2121                 if (! fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().shadow)
2122                     compArg = 3;
2123                 // check for constant offsets
2124                 int offsetArg = fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().shadow ? 3 : 2;
2125                 if (! callNode.getSequence()[offsetArg]->getAsConstantUnion())
2126                     error(loc, "must be a compile-time constant:", feature, "offsets argument");
2127             } else if (fnCandidate.getName().compare("textureGather") == 0) {
2128                 // More than two arguments needs gpu_shader5, and rectangular or shadow needs gpu_shader5,
2129                 // otherwise, need GL_ARB_texture_gather.
2130                 if (fnCandidate.getParamCount() > 2 || fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().dim == EsdRect || fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().shadow) {
2131                     profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 400, E_GL_ARB_gpu_shader5, feature);
2132                     if (! fnCandidate[0].type->getSampler().shadow)
2133                         compArg = 2;
2134                 } else
2135                     profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 400, E_GL_ARB_texture_gather, feature);
2136             }
2137 
2138             if (compArg > 0 && compArg < fnCandidate.getParamCount()) {
2139                 if (callNode.getSequence()[compArg]->getAsConstantUnion()) {
2140                     int value = callNode.getSequence()[compArg]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
2141                     if (value < 0 || value > 3)
2142                         error(loc, "must be 0, 1, 2, or 3:", feature, "component argument");
2143                 } else
2144                     error(loc, "must be a compile-time constant:", feature, "component argument");
2145             }
2146         } else {
2147             // this is only for functions not starting "textureGather"...
2148             if (fnCandidate.getName().find("Offset") != TString::npos) {
2149 
2150                 // Handle texture-offset limits checking
2151                 int arg = -1;
2152                 if (fnCandidate.getName().compare("textureOffset") == 0)
2153                     arg = 2;
2154                 else if (fnCandidate.getName().compare("texelFetchOffset") == 0)
2155                     arg = 3;
2156                 else if (fnCandidate.getName().compare("textureProjOffset") == 0)
2157                     arg = 2;
2158                 else if (fnCandidate.getName().compare("textureLodOffset") == 0)
2159                     arg = 3;
2160                 else if (fnCandidate.getName().compare("textureProjLodOffset") == 0)
2161                     arg = 3;
2162                 else if (fnCandidate.getName().compare("textureGradOffset") == 0)
2163                     arg = 4;
2164                 else if (fnCandidate.getName().compare("textureProjGradOffset") == 0)
2165                     arg = 4;
2166 
2167                 if (arg > 0) {
2168                     if (! callNode.getSequence()[arg]->getAsConstantUnion())
2169                         error(loc, "argument must be compile-time constant", "texel offset", "");
2170                     else {
2171                         const TType& type = callNode.getSequence()[arg]->getAsTyped()->getType();
2172                         for (int c = 0; c < type.getVectorSize(); ++c) {
2173                             int offset = callNode.getSequence()[arg]->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[c].getIConst();
2174                             if (offset > resources.maxProgramTexelOffset || offset < resources.minProgramTexelOffset)
2175                                 error(loc, "value is out of range:", "texel offset", "[gl_MinProgramTexelOffset, gl_MaxProgramTexelOffset]");
2176                         }
2177                     }
2178                 }
2179             }
2180         }
2181     }
2182 
2183     // GL_ARB_shader_texture_image_samples
2184     if (fnCandidate.getName().compare(0, 14, "textureSamples") == 0 || fnCandidate.getName().compare(0, 12, "imageSamples") == 0)
2185         profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 450, E_GL_ARB_shader_texture_image_samples, "textureSamples and imageSamples");
2186 
2187     if (fnCandidate.getName().compare(0, 11, "imageAtomic") == 0) {
2188         const TType& imageType = callNode.getSequence()[0]->getAsTyped()->getType();
2189         if (imageType.getSampler().type == EbtInt || imageType.getSampler().type == EbtUint) {
2190             if (imageType.getQualifier().layoutFormat != ElfR32i && imageType.getQualifier().layoutFormat != ElfR32ui)
2191                 error(loc, "only supported on image with format r32i or r32ui", fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
2192         } else {
2193             if (fnCandidate.getName().compare(0, 19, "imageAtomicExchange") != 0)
2194                 error(loc, "only supported on integer images", fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
2195             else if (imageType.getQualifier().layoutFormat != ElfR32f && profile == EEsProfile)
2196                 error(loc, "only supported on image with format r32f", fnCandidate.getName().c_str(), "");
2197         }
2198     }
2199 }
2200 
2201 //
2202 // Do any extra checking for a user function call.
2203 //
userFunctionCallCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,TIntermAggregate & callNode)2204 void TParseContext::userFunctionCallCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, TIntermAggregate& callNode)
2205 {
2206     TIntermSequence& arguments = callNode.getSequence();
2207 
2208     for (int i = 0; i < (int)arguments.size(); ++i)
2209         samplerConstructorLocationCheck(loc, "call argument", arguments[i]);
2210 }
2211 
2212 //
2213 // Emit an error if this is a sampler constructor
2214 //
samplerConstructorLocationCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const char * token,TIntermNode * node)2215 void TParseContext::samplerConstructorLocationCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const char* token, TIntermNode* node)
2216 {
2217     if (node->getAsOperator() && node->getAsOperator()->getOp() == EOpConstructTextureSampler)
2218         error(loc, "sampler constructor must appear at point of use", token, "");
2219 }
2220 
2221 //
2222 // Handle seeing a built-in constructor in a grammar production.
2223 //
handleConstructorCall(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TPublicType & publicType)2224 TFunction* TParseContext::handleConstructorCall(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TPublicType& publicType)
2225 {
2226     TType type(publicType);
2227     type.getQualifier().precision = EpqNone;
2228 
2229     if (type.isArray()) {
2230         profileRequires(loc, ENoProfile, 120, E_GL_3DL_array_objects, "arrayed constructor");
2231         profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, "arrayed constructor");
2232     }
2233 
2234     TOperator op = intermediate.mapTypeToConstructorOp(type);
2235 
2236     if (op == EOpNull) {
2237         error(loc, "cannot construct this type", type.getBasicString(), "");
2238         op = EOpConstructFloat;
2239         TType errorType(EbtFloat);
2240         type.shallowCopy(errorType);
2241     }
2242 
2243     TString empty("");
2244 
2245     return new TFunction(&empty, type, op);
2246 }
2247 
2248 // Handle seeing a precision qualifier in the grammar.
handlePrecisionQualifier(const TSourceLoc &,TQualifier & qualifier,TPrecisionQualifier precision)2249 void TParseContext::handlePrecisionQualifier(const TSourceLoc& /*loc*/, TQualifier& qualifier, TPrecisionQualifier precision)
2250 {
2251     if (obeyPrecisionQualifiers())
2252         qualifier.precision = precision;
2253 }
2254 
2255 // Check for messages to give on seeing a precision qualifier used in a
2256 // declaration in the grammar.
checkPrecisionQualifier(const TSourceLoc & loc,TPrecisionQualifier)2257 void TParseContext::checkPrecisionQualifier(const TSourceLoc& loc, TPrecisionQualifier)
2258 {
2259     if (precisionManager.shouldWarnAboutDefaults()) {
2260         warn(loc, "all default precisions are highp; use precision statements to quiet warning, e.g.:\n"
2261                   "         \"precision mediump int; precision highp float;\"", "", "");
2262         precisionManager.defaultWarningGiven();
2263     }
2264 }
2265 
2266 //
2267 // Same error message for all places assignments don't work.
2268 //
assignError(const TSourceLoc & loc,const char * op,TString left,TString right)2269 void TParseContext::assignError(const TSourceLoc& loc, const char* op, TString left, TString right)
2270 {
2271     error(loc, "", op, "cannot convert from '%s' to '%s'",
2272           right.c_str(), left.c_str());
2273 }
2274 
2275 //
2276 // Same error message for all places unary operations don't work.
2277 //
unaryOpError(const TSourceLoc & loc,const char * op,TString operand)2278 void TParseContext::unaryOpError(const TSourceLoc& loc, const char* op, TString operand)
2279 {
2280    error(loc, " wrong operand type", op,
2281           "no operation '%s' exists that takes an operand of type %s (or there is no acceptable conversion)",
2282           op, operand.c_str());
2283 }
2284 
2285 //
2286 // Same error message for all binary operations don't work.
2287 //
binaryOpError(const TSourceLoc & loc,const char * op,TString left,TString right)2288 void TParseContext::binaryOpError(const TSourceLoc& loc, const char* op, TString left, TString right)
2289 {
2290     error(loc, " wrong operand types:", op,
2291             "no operation '%s' exists that takes a left-hand operand of type '%s' and "
2292             "a right operand of type '%s' (or there is no acceptable conversion)",
2293             op, left.c_str(), right.c_str());
2294 }
2295 
2296 //
2297 // A basic type of EbtVoid is a key that the name string was seen in the source, but
2298 // it was not found as a variable in the symbol table.  If so, give the error
2299 // message and insert a dummy variable in the symbol table to prevent future errors.
2300 //
variableCheck(TIntermTyped * & nodePtr)2301 void TParseContext::variableCheck(TIntermTyped*& nodePtr)
2302 {
2303     TIntermSymbol* symbol = nodePtr->getAsSymbolNode();
2304     if (! symbol)
2305         return;
2306 
2307     if (symbol->getType().getBasicType() == EbtVoid) {
2308         const char *extraInfoFormat = "";
2309         if (spvVersion.vulkan != 0 && symbol->getName() == "gl_VertexID") {
2310           extraInfoFormat = "(Did you mean gl_VertexIndex?)";
2311         } else if (spvVersion.vulkan != 0 && symbol->getName() == "gl_InstanceID") {
2312           extraInfoFormat = "(Did you mean gl_InstanceIndex?)";
2313         }
2314         error(symbol->getLoc(), "undeclared identifier", symbol->getName().c_str(), extraInfoFormat);
2315 
2316         // Add to symbol table to prevent future error messages on the same name
2317         if (symbol->getName().size() > 0) {
2318             TVariable* fakeVariable = new TVariable(&symbol->getName(), TType(EbtFloat));
2319             symbolTable.insert(*fakeVariable);
2320 
2321             // substitute a symbol node for this new variable
2322             nodePtr = intermediate.addSymbol(*fakeVariable, symbol->getLoc());
2323         }
2324     } else {
2325         switch (symbol->getQualifier().storage) {
2326         case EvqPointCoord:
2327             profileRequires(symbol->getLoc(), ENoProfile, 120, nullptr, "gl_PointCoord");
2328             break;
2329         default: break; // some compilers want this
2330         }
2331     }
2332 }
2333 
2334 //
2335 // Both test and if necessary, spit out an error, to see if the node is really
2336 // an l-value that can be operated on this way.
2337 //
2338 // Returns true if there was an error.
2339 //
lValueErrorCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const char * op,TIntermTyped * node)2340 bool TParseContext::lValueErrorCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const char* op, TIntermTyped* node)
2341 {
2342     TIntermBinary* binaryNode = node->getAsBinaryNode();
2343 
2344     if (binaryNode) {
2345         bool errorReturn = false;
2346 
2347         switch(binaryNode->getOp()) {
2348         case EOpIndexDirect:
2349         case EOpIndexIndirect:
2350             // ...  tessellation control shader ...
2351             // If a per-vertex output variable is used as an l-value, it is a
2352             // compile-time or link-time error if the expression indicating the
2353             // vertex index is not the identifier gl_InvocationID.
2354             if (language == EShLangTessControl) {
2355                 const TType& leftType = binaryNode->getLeft()->getType();
2356                 if (leftType.getQualifier().storage == EvqVaryingOut && ! leftType.getQualifier().patch && binaryNode->getLeft()->getAsSymbolNode()) {
2357                     // we have a per-vertex output
2358                     const TIntermSymbol* rightSymbol = binaryNode->getRight()->getAsSymbolNode();
2359                     if (! rightSymbol || rightSymbol->getQualifier().builtIn != EbvInvocationId)
2360                         error(loc, "tessellation-control per-vertex output l-value must be indexed with gl_InvocationID", "[]", "");
2361                 }
2362             }
2363 
2364             break; // left node is checked by base class
2365         case EOpIndexDirectStruct:
2366             break; // left node is checked by base class
2367         case EOpVectorSwizzle:
2368             errorReturn = lValueErrorCheck(loc, op, binaryNode->getLeft());
2369             if (!errorReturn) {
2370                 int offset[4] = {0,0,0,0};
2371 
2372                 TIntermTyped* rightNode = binaryNode->getRight();
2373                 TIntermAggregate *aggrNode = rightNode->getAsAggregate();
2374 
2375                 for (TIntermSequence::iterator p = aggrNode->getSequence().begin();
2376                                                p != aggrNode->getSequence().end(); p++) {
2377                     int value = (*p)->getAsTyped()->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
2378                     offset[value]++;
2379                     if (offset[value] > 1) {
2380                         error(loc, " l-value of swizzle cannot have duplicate components", op, "", "");
2381 
2382                         return true;
2383                     }
2384                 }
2385             }
2386 
2387             return errorReturn;
2388         default:
2389             break;
2390         }
2391 
2392         if (errorReturn) {
2393             error(loc, " l-value required", op, "", "");
2394             return true;
2395         }
2396     }
2397 
2398     if (binaryNode && binaryNode->getOp() == EOpIndexDirectStruct &&
2399         binaryNode->getLeft()->getBasicType() == EbtReference)
2400         return false;
2401 
2402     // Let the base class check errors
2403     if (TParseContextBase::lValueErrorCheck(loc, op, node))
2404         return true;
2405 
2406     const char* symbol = nullptr;
2407     TIntermSymbol* symNode = node->getAsSymbolNode();
2408     if (symNode != nullptr)
2409         symbol = symNode->getName().c_str();
2410 
2411     const char* message = nullptr;
2412     switch (node->getQualifier().storage) {
2413     case EvqVaryingIn:      message = "can't modify shader input";   break;
2414     case EvqInstanceId:     message = "can't modify gl_InstanceID";  break;
2415     case EvqVertexId:       message = "can't modify gl_VertexID";    break;
2416     case EvqFace:           message = "can't modify gl_FrontFace";   break;
2417     case EvqFragCoord:      message = "can't modify gl_FragCoord";   break;
2418     case EvqPointCoord:     message = "can't modify gl_PointCoord";  break;
2419     case EvqFragDepth:
2420         intermediate.setDepthReplacing();
2421         // "In addition, it is an error to statically write to gl_FragDepth in the fragment shader."
2422         if (profile == EEsProfile && intermediate.getEarlyFragmentTests())
2423             message = "can't modify gl_FragDepth if using early_fragment_tests";
2424         break;
2425 
2426     default:
2427         break;
2428     }
2429 
2430     if (message == nullptr && binaryNode == nullptr && symNode == nullptr) {
2431         error(loc, " l-value required", op, "", "");
2432 
2433         return true;
2434     }
2435 
2436     //
2437     // Everything else is okay, no error.
2438     //
2439     if (message == nullptr)
2440         return false;
2441 
2442     //
2443     // If we get here, we have an error and a message.
2444     //
2445     if (symNode)
2446         error(loc, " l-value required", op, "\"%s\" (%s)", symbol, message);
2447     else
2448         error(loc, " l-value required", op, "(%s)", message);
2449 
2450     return true;
2451 }
2452 
2453 // Test for and give an error if the node can't be read from.
rValueErrorCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const char * op,TIntermTyped * node)2454 void TParseContext::rValueErrorCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const char* op, TIntermTyped* node)
2455 {
2456     // Let the base class check errors
2457     TParseContextBase::rValueErrorCheck(loc, op, node);
2458 
2459 #ifdef AMD_EXTENSIONS
2460     TIntermSymbol* symNode = node->getAsSymbolNode();
2461     if (!(symNode && symNode->getQualifier().writeonly)) // base class checks
2462         if (symNode && symNode->getQualifier().explicitInterp)
2463             error(loc, "can't read from explicitly-interpolated object: ", op, symNode->getName().c_str());
2464 #endif
2465 }
2466 
2467 //
2468 // Both test, and if necessary spit out an error, to see if the node is really
2469 // a constant.
2470 //
constantValueCheck(TIntermTyped * node,const char * token)2471 void TParseContext::constantValueCheck(TIntermTyped* node, const char* token)
2472 {
2473     if (! node->getQualifier().isConstant())
2474         error(node->getLoc(), "constant expression required", token, "");
2475 }
2476 
2477 //
2478 // Both test, and if necessary spit out an error, to see if the node is really
2479 // an integer.
2480 //
integerCheck(const TIntermTyped * node,const char * token)2481 void TParseContext::integerCheck(const TIntermTyped* node, const char* token)
2482 {
2483     if ((node->getBasicType() == EbtInt || node->getBasicType() == EbtUint) && node->isScalar())
2484         return;
2485 
2486     error(node->getLoc(), "scalar integer expression required", token, "");
2487 }
2488 
2489 //
2490 // Both test, and if necessary spit out an error, to see if we are currently
2491 // globally scoped.
2492 //
globalCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const char * token)2493 void TParseContext::globalCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const char* token)
2494 {
2495     if (! symbolTable.atGlobalLevel())
2496         error(loc, "not allowed in nested scope", token, "");
2497 }
2498 
2499 //
2500 // Reserved errors for GLSL.
2501 //
reservedErrorCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TString & identifier)2502 void TParseContext::reservedErrorCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TString& identifier)
2503 {
2504     // "Identifiers starting with "gl_" are reserved for use by OpenGL, and may not be
2505     // declared in a shader; this results in a compile-time error."
2506     if (! symbolTable.atBuiltInLevel()) {
2507         if (builtInName(identifier))
2508             error(loc, "identifiers starting with \"gl_\" are reserved", identifier.c_str(), "");
2509 
2510         // "__" are not supposed to be an error.  ES 310 (and desktop) added the clarification:
2511         // "In addition, all identifiers containing two consecutive underscores (__) are
2512         // reserved; using such a name does not itself result in an error, but may result
2513         // in undefined behavior."
2514         // however, before that, ES tests required an error.
2515         if (identifier.find("__") != TString::npos) {
2516             if (profile == EEsProfile && version <= 300)
2517                 error(loc, "identifiers containing consecutive underscores (\"__\") are reserved, and an error if version <= 300", identifier.c_str(), "");
2518             else
2519                 warn(loc, "identifiers containing consecutive underscores (\"__\") are reserved", identifier.c_str(), "");
2520         }
2521     }
2522 }
2523 
2524 //
2525 // Reserved errors for the preprocessor.
2526 //
reservedPpErrorCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const char * identifier,const char * op)2527 void TParseContext::reservedPpErrorCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const char* identifier, const char* op)
2528 {
2529     // "__" are not supposed to be an error.  ES 310 (and desktop) added the clarification:
2530     // "All macro names containing two consecutive underscores ( __ ) are reserved;
2531     // defining such a name does not itself result in an error, but may result in
2532     // undefined behavior.  All macro names prefixed with "GL_" ("GL" followed by a
2533     // single underscore) are also reserved, and defining such a name results in a
2534     // compile-time error."
2535     // however, before that, ES tests required an error.
2536     if (strncmp(identifier, "GL_", 3) == 0)
2537         ppError(loc, "names beginning with \"GL_\" can't be (un)defined:", op,  identifier);
2538     else if (strncmp(identifier, "defined", 8) == 0)
2539         ppError(loc, "\"defined\" can't be (un)defined:", op,  identifier);
2540     else if (strstr(identifier, "__") != 0) {
2541         if (profile == EEsProfile && version >= 300 &&
2542             (strcmp(identifier, "__LINE__") == 0 ||
2543              strcmp(identifier, "__FILE__") == 0 ||
2544              strcmp(identifier, "__VERSION__") == 0))
2545             ppError(loc, "predefined names can't be (un)defined:", op,  identifier);
2546         else {
2547             if (profile == EEsProfile && version <= 300)
2548                 ppError(loc, "names containing consecutive underscores are reserved, and an error if version <= 300:", op, identifier);
2549             else
2550                 ppWarn(loc, "names containing consecutive underscores are reserved:", op, identifier);
2551         }
2552     }
2553 }
2554 
2555 //
2556 // See if this version/profile allows use of the line-continuation character '\'.
2557 //
2558 // Returns true if a line continuation should be done.
2559 //
lineContinuationCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,bool endOfComment)2560 bool TParseContext::lineContinuationCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, bool endOfComment)
2561 {
2562     const char* message = "line continuation";
2563 
2564     bool lineContinuationAllowed = (profile == EEsProfile && version >= 300) ||
2565                                    (profile != EEsProfile && (version >= 420 || extensionTurnedOn(E_GL_ARB_shading_language_420pack)));
2566 
2567     if (endOfComment) {
2568         if (lineContinuationAllowed)
2569             warn(loc, "used at end of comment; the following line is still part of the comment", message, "");
2570         else
2571             warn(loc, "used at end of comment, but this version does not provide line continuation", message, "");
2572 
2573         return lineContinuationAllowed;
2574     }
2575 
2576     if (relaxedErrors()) {
2577         if (! lineContinuationAllowed)
2578             warn(loc, "not allowed in this version", message, "");
2579         return true;
2580     } else {
2581         profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, message);
2582         profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 420, E_GL_ARB_shading_language_420pack, message);
2583     }
2584 
2585     return lineContinuationAllowed;
2586 }
2587 
builtInName(const TString & identifier)2588 bool TParseContext::builtInName(const TString& identifier)
2589 {
2590     return identifier.compare(0, 3, "gl_") == 0;
2591 }
2592 
2593 //
2594 // Make sure there is enough data and not too many arguments provided to the
2595 // constructor to build something of the type of the constructor.  Also returns
2596 // the type of the constructor.
2597 //
2598 // Part of establishing type is establishing specialization-constness.
2599 // We don't yet know "top down" whether type is a specialization constant,
2600 // but a const constructor can becomes a specialization constant if any of
2601 // its children are, subject to KHR_vulkan_glsl rules:
2602 //
2603 //     - int(), uint(), and bool() constructors for type conversions
2604 //       from any of the following types to any of the following types:
2605 //         * int
2606 //         * uint
2607 //         * bool
2608 //     - vector versions of the above conversion constructors
2609 //
2610 // Returns true if there was an error in construction.
2611 //
constructorError(const TSourceLoc & loc,TIntermNode * node,TFunction & function,TOperator op,TType & type)2612 bool TParseContext::constructorError(const TSourceLoc& loc, TIntermNode* node, TFunction& function, TOperator op, TType& type)
2613 {
2614     type.shallowCopy(function.getType());
2615 
2616     bool constructingMatrix = false;
2617     switch(op) {
2618     case EOpConstructTextureSampler:
2619         return constructorTextureSamplerError(loc, function);
2620     case EOpConstructMat2x2:
2621     case EOpConstructMat2x3:
2622     case EOpConstructMat2x4:
2623     case EOpConstructMat3x2:
2624     case EOpConstructMat3x3:
2625     case EOpConstructMat3x4:
2626     case EOpConstructMat4x2:
2627     case EOpConstructMat4x3:
2628     case EOpConstructMat4x4:
2629     case EOpConstructDMat2x2:
2630     case EOpConstructDMat2x3:
2631     case EOpConstructDMat2x4:
2632     case EOpConstructDMat3x2:
2633     case EOpConstructDMat3x3:
2634     case EOpConstructDMat3x4:
2635     case EOpConstructDMat4x2:
2636     case EOpConstructDMat4x3:
2637     case EOpConstructDMat4x4:
2638     case EOpConstructF16Mat2x2:
2639     case EOpConstructF16Mat2x3:
2640     case EOpConstructF16Mat2x4:
2641     case EOpConstructF16Mat3x2:
2642     case EOpConstructF16Mat3x3:
2643     case EOpConstructF16Mat3x4:
2644     case EOpConstructF16Mat4x2:
2645     case EOpConstructF16Mat4x3:
2646     case EOpConstructF16Mat4x4:
2647         constructingMatrix = true;
2648         break;
2649     default:
2650         break;
2651     }
2652 
2653     //
2654     // Walk the arguments for first-pass checks and collection of information.
2655     //
2656 
2657     int size = 0;
2658     bool constType = true;
2659     bool specConstType = false;   // value is only valid if constType is true
2660     bool full = false;
2661     bool overFull = false;
2662     bool matrixInMatrix = false;
2663     bool arrayArg = false;
2664     bool floatArgument = false;
2665     for (int arg = 0; arg < function.getParamCount(); ++arg) {
2666         if (function[arg].type->isArray()) {
2667             if (function[arg].type->isUnsizedArray()) {
2668                 // Can't construct from an unsized array.
2669                 error(loc, "array argument must be sized", "constructor", "");
2670                 return true;
2671             }
2672             arrayArg = true;
2673         }
2674         if (constructingMatrix && function[arg].type->isMatrix())
2675             matrixInMatrix = true;
2676 
2677         // 'full' will go to true when enough args have been seen.  If we loop
2678         // again, there is an extra argument.
2679         if (full) {
2680             // For vectors and matrices, it's okay to have too many components
2681             // available, but not okay to have unused arguments.
2682             overFull = true;
2683         }
2684 
2685         size += function[arg].type->computeNumComponents();
2686         if (op != EOpConstructStruct && ! type.isArray() && size >= type.computeNumComponents())
2687             full = true;
2688 
2689         if (! function[arg].type->getQualifier().isConstant())
2690             constType = false;
2691         if (function[arg].type->getQualifier().isSpecConstant())
2692             specConstType = true;
2693         if (function[arg].type->isFloatingDomain())
2694             floatArgument = true;
2695         if (type.isStruct()) {
2696             if (function[arg].type->containsBasicType(EbtFloat16)) {
2697                 requireFloat16Arithmetic(loc, "constructor", "can't construct structure containing 16-bit type");
2698             }
2699             if (function[arg].type->containsBasicType(EbtUint16) ||
2700                 function[arg].type->containsBasicType(EbtInt16)) {
2701                 requireInt16Arithmetic(loc, "constructor", "can't construct structure containing 16-bit type");
2702             }
2703             if (function[arg].type->containsBasicType(EbtUint8) ||
2704                 function[arg].type->containsBasicType(EbtInt8)) {
2705                 requireInt8Arithmetic(loc, "constructor", "can't construct structure containing 8-bit type");
2706             }
2707         }
2708     }
2709 
2710     switch (op) {
2711     case EOpConstructFloat16:
2712     case EOpConstructF16Vec2:
2713     case EOpConstructF16Vec3:
2714     case EOpConstructF16Vec4:
2715         if (type.isArray())
2716             requireFloat16Arithmetic(loc, "constructor", "16-bit arrays not supported");
2717         if (type.isVector() && function.getParamCount() != 1)
2718             requireFloat16Arithmetic(loc, "constructor", "16-bit vectors only take vector types");
2719         break;
2720     case EOpConstructUint16:
2721     case EOpConstructU16Vec2:
2722     case EOpConstructU16Vec3:
2723     case EOpConstructU16Vec4:
2724     case EOpConstructInt16:
2725     case EOpConstructI16Vec2:
2726     case EOpConstructI16Vec3:
2727     case EOpConstructI16Vec4:
2728         if (type.isArray())
2729             requireInt16Arithmetic(loc, "constructor", "16-bit arrays not supported");
2730         if (type.isVector() && function.getParamCount() != 1)
2731             requireInt16Arithmetic(loc, "constructor", "16-bit vectors only take vector types");
2732         break;
2733     case EOpConstructUint8:
2734     case EOpConstructU8Vec2:
2735     case EOpConstructU8Vec3:
2736     case EOpConstructU8Vec4:
2737     case EOpConstructInt8:
2738     case EOpConstructI8Vec2:
2739     case EOpConstructI8Vec3:
2740     case EOpConstructI8Vec4:
2741         if (type.isArray())
2742             requireInt8Arithmetic(loc, "constructor", "8-bit arrays not supported");
2743         if (type.isVector() && function.getParamCount() != 1)
2744             requireInt8Arithmetic(loc, "constructor", "8-bit vectors only take vector types");
2745         break;
2746     default:
2747         break;
2748     }
2749 
2750     // inherit constness from children
2751     if (constType) {
2752         bool makeSpecConst;
2753         // Finish pinning down spec-const semantics
2754         if (specConstType) {
2755             switch (op) {
2756             case EOpConstructInt8:
2757             case EOpConstructUint8:
2758             case EOpConstructInt16:
2759             case EOpConstructUint16:
2760             case EOpConstructInt:
2761             case EOpConstructUint:
2762             case EOpConstructInt64:
2763             case EOpConstructUint64:
2764             case EOpConstructBool:
2765             case EOpConstructBVec2:
2766             case EOpConstructBVec3:
2767             case EOpConstructBVec4:
2768             case EOpConstructI8Vec2:
2769             case EOpConstructI8Vec3:
2770             case EOpConstructI8Vec4:
2771             case EOpConstructU8Vec2:
2772             case EOpConstructU8Vec3:
2773             case EOpConstructU8Vec4:
2774             case EOpConstructI16Vec2:
2775             case EOpConstructI16Vec3:
2776             case EOpConstructI16Vec4:
2777             case EOpConstructU16Vec2:
2778             case EOpConstructU16Vec3:
2779             case EOpConstructU16Vec4:
2780             case EOpConstructIVec2:
2781             case EOpConstructIVec3:
2782             case EOpConstructIVec4:
2783             case EOpConstructUVec2:
2784             case EOpConstructUVec3:
2785             case EOpConstructUVec4:
2786             case EOpConstructI64Vec2:
2787             case EOpConstructI64Vec3:
2788             case EOpConstructI64Vec4:
2789             case EOpConstructU64Vec2:
2790             case EOpConstructU64Vec3:
2791             case EOpConstructU64Vec4:
2792                 // This was the list of valid ones, if they aren't converting from float
2793                 // and aren't making an array.
2794                 makeSpecConst = ! floatArgument && ! type.isArray();
2795                 break;
2796             default:
2797                 // anything else wasn't white-listed in the spec as a conversion
2798                 makeSpecConst = false;
2799                 break;
2800             }
2801         } else
2802             makeSpecConst = false;
2803 
2804         if (makeSpecConst)
2805             type.getQualifier().makeSpecConstant();
2806         else if (specConstType)
2807             type.getQualifier().makeTemporary();
2808         else
2809             type.getQualifier().storage = EvqConst;
2810     }
2811 
2812     if (type.isArray()) {
2813         if (function.getParamCount() == 0) {
2814             error(loc, "array constructor must have at least one argument", "constructor", "");
2815             return true;
2816         }
2817 
2818         if (type.isUnsizedArray()) {
2819             // auto adapt the constructor type to the number of arguments
2820             type.changeOuterArraySize(function.getParamCount());
2821         } else if (type.getOuterArraySize() != function.getParamCount()) {
2822             error(loc, "array constructor needs one argument per array element", "constructor", "");
2823             return true;
2824         }
2825 
2826         if (type.isArrayOfArrays()) {
2827             // Types have to match, but we're still making the type.
2828             // Finish making the type, and the comparison is done later
2829             // when checking for conversion.
2830             TArraySizes& arraySizes = *type.getArraySizes();
2831 
2832             // At least the dimensionalities have to match.
2833             if (! function[0].type->isArray() ||
2834                     arraySizes.getNumDims() != function[0].type->getArraySizes()->getNumDims() + 1) {
2835                 error(loc, "array constructor argument not correct type to construct array element", "constructor", "");
2836                 return true;
2837             }
2838 
2839             if (arraySizes.isInnerUnsized()) {
2840                 // "Arrays of arrays ..., and the size for any dimension is optional"
2841                 // That means we need to adopt (from the first argument) the other array sizes into the type.
2842                 for (int d = 1; d < arraySizes.getNumDims(); ++d) {
2843                     if (arraySizes.getDimSize(d) == UnsizedArraySize) {
2844                         arraySizes.setDimSize(d, function[0].type->getArraySizes()->getDimSize(d - 1));
2845                     }
2846                 }
2847             }
2848         }
2849     }
2850 
2851     if (arrayArg && op != EOpConstructStruct && ! type.isArrayOfArrays()) {
2852         error(loc, "constructing non-array constituent from array argument", "constructor", "");
2853         return true;
2854     }
2855 
2856     if (matrixInMatrix && ! type.isArray()) {
2857         profileRequires(loc, ENoProfile, 120, nullptr, "constructing matrix from matrix");
2858 
2859         // "If a matrix argument is given to a matrix constructor,
2860         // it is a compile-time error to have any other arguments."
2861         if (function.getParamCount() != 1)
2862             error(loc, "matrix constructed from matrix can only have one argument", "constructor", "");
2863         return false;
2864     }
2865 
2866     if (overFull) {
2867         error(loc, "too many arguments", "constructor", "");
2868         return true;
2869     }
2870 
2871     if (op == EOpConstructStruct && ! type.isArray() && (int)type.getStruct()->size() != function.getParamCount()) {
2872         error(loc, "Number of constructor parameters does not match the number of structure fields", "constructor", "");
2873         return true;
2874     }
2875 
2876     if ((op != EOpConstructStruct && size != 1 && size < type.computeNumComponents()) ||
2877         (op == EOpConstructStruct && size < type.computeNumComponents())) {
2878         error(loc, "not enough data provided for construction", "constructor", "");
2879         return true;
2880     }
2881 
2882     TIntermTyped* typed = node->getAsTyped();
2883     if (typed == nullptr) {
2884         error(loc, "constructor argument does not have a type", "constructor", "");
2885         return true;
2886     }
2887     if (op != EOpConstructStruct && typed->getBasicType() == EbtSampler) {
2888         error(loc, "cannot convert a sampler", "constructor", "");
2889         return true;
2890     }
2891     if (op != EOpConstructStruct && typed->getBasicType() == EbtAtomicUint) {
2892         error(loc, "cannot convert an atomic_uint", "constructor", "");
2893         return true;
2894     }
2895     if (typed->getBasicType() == EbtVoid) {
2896         error(loc, "cannot convert a void", "constructor", "");
2897         return true;
2898     }
2899 
2900     return false;
2901 }
2902 
2903 // Verify all the correct semantics for constructing a combined texture/sampler.
2904 // Return true if the semantics are incorrect.
constructorTextureSamplerError(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TFunction & function)2905 bool TParseContext::constructorTextureSamplerError(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TFunction& function)
2906 {
2907     TString constructorName = function.getType().getBasicTypeString();  // TODO: performance: should not be making copy; interface needs to change
2908     const char* token = constructorName.c_str();
2909 
2910     // exactly two arguments needed
2911     if (function.getParamCount() != 2) {
2912         error(loc, "sampler-constructor requires two arguments", token, "");
2913         return true;
2914     }
2915 
2916     // For now, not allowing arrayed constructors, the rest of this function
2917     // is set up to allow them, if this test is removed:
2918     if (function.getType().isArray()) {
2919         error(loc, "sampler-constructor cannot make an array of samplers", token, "");
2920         return true;
2921     }
2922 
2923     // first argument
2924     //  * the constructor's first argument must be a texture type
2925     //  * the dimensionality (1D, 2D, 3D, Cube, Rect, Buffer, MS, and Array)
2926     //    of the texture type must match that of the constructed sampler type
2927     //    (that is, the suffixes of the type of the first argument and the
2928     //    type of the constructor will be spelled the same way)
2929     if (function[0].type->getBasicType() != EbtSampler ||
2930         ! function[0].type->getSampler().isTexture() ||
2931         function[0].type->isArray()) {
2932         error(loc, "sampler-constructor first argument must be a scalar textureXXX type", token, "");
2933         return true;
2934     }
2935     // simulate the first argument's impact on the result type, so it can be compared with the encapsulated operator!=()
2936     TSampler texture = function.getType().getSampler();
2937     texture.combined = false;
2938     texture.shadow = false;
2939     if (texture != function[0].type->getSampler()) {
2940         error(loc, "sampler-constructor first argument must match type and dimensionality of constructor type", token, "");
2941         return true;
2942     }
2943 
2944     // second argument
2945     //   * the constructor's second argument must be a scalar of type
2946     //     *sampler* or *samplerShadow*
2947     if (  function[1].type->getBasicType() != EbtSampler ||
2948         ! function[1].type->getSampler().isPureSampler() ||
2949           function[1].type->isArray()) {
2950         error(loc, "sampler-constructor second argument must be a scalar type 'sampler'", token, "");
2951         return true;
2952     }
2953 
2954     return false;
2955 }
2956 
2957 // Checks to see if a void variable has been declared and raise an error message for such a case
2958 //
2959 // returns true in case of an error
2960 //
voidErrorCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TString & identifier,const TBasicType basicType)2961 bool TParseContext::voidErrorCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TString& identifier, const TBasicType basicType)
2962 {
2963     if (basicType == EbtVoid) {
2964         error(loc, "illegal use of type 'void'", identifier.c_str(), "");
2965         return true;
2966     }
2967 
2968     return false;
2969 }
2970 
2971 // Checks to see if the node (for the expression) contains a scalar boolean expression or not
boolCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TIntermTyped * type)2972 void TParseContext::boolCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TIntermTyped* type)
2973 {
2974     if (type->getBasicType() != EbtBool || type->isArray() || type->isMatrix() || type->isVector())
2975         error(loc, "boolean expression expected", "", "");
2976 }
2977 
2978 // This function checks to see if the node (for the expression) contains a scalar boolean expression or not
boolCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TPublicType & pType)2979 void TParseContext::boolCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TPublicType& pType)
2980 {
2981     if (pType.basicType != EbtBool || pType.arraySizes || pType.matrixCols > 1 || (pType.vectorSize > 1))
2982         error(loc, "boolean expression expected", "", "");
2983 }
2984 
samplerCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TType & type,const TString & identifier,TIntermTyped *)2985 void TParseContext::samplerCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TType& type, const TString& identifier, TIntermTyped* /*initializer*/)
2986 {
2987     // Check that the appropriate extension is enabled if external sampler is used.
2988     // There are two extensions. The correct one must be used based on GLSL version.
2989     if (type.getBasicType() == EbtSampler && type.getSampler().external) {
2990         if (version < 300) {
2991             requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_OES_EGL_image_external, "samplerExternalOES");
2992         } else {
2993             requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_OES_EGL_image_external_essl3, "samplerExternalOES");
2994         }
2995     }
2996 
2997     if (type.getQualifier().storage == EvqUniform)
2998         return;
2999 
3000     if (type.getBasicType() == EbtStruct && containsFieldWithBasicType(type, EbtSampler))
3001         error(loc, "non-uniform struct contains a sampler or image:", type.getBasicTypeString().c_str(), identifier.c_str());
3002     else if (type.getBasicType() == EbtSampler && type.getQualifier().storage != EvqUniform) {
3003         // non-uniform sampler
3004         // not yet:  okay if it has an initializer
3005         // if (! initializer)
3006         error(loc, "sampler/image types can only be used in uniform variables or function parameters:", type.getBasicTypeString().c_str(), identifier.c_str());
3007     }
3008 }
3009 
atomicUintCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TType & type,const TString & identifier)3010 void TParseContext::atomicUintCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TType& type, const TString& identifier)
3011 {
3012     if (type.getQualifier().storage == EvqUniform)
3013         return;
3014 
3015     if (type.getBasicType() == EbtStruct && containsFieldWithBasicType(type, EbtAtomicUint))
3016         error(loc, "non-uniform struct contains an atomic_uint:", type.getBasicTypeString().c_str(), identifier.c_str());
3017     else if (type.getBasicType() == EbtAtomicUint && type.getQualifier().storage != EvqUniform)
3018         error(loc, "atomic_uints can only be used in uniform variables or function parameters:", type.getBasicTypeString().c_str(), identifier.c_str());
3019 }
3020 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
accStructNVCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TType & type,const TString & identifier)3021 void TParseContext::accStructNVCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TType& type, const TString& identifier)
3022 {
3023     if (type.getQualifier().storage == EvqUniform)
3024         return;
3025 
3026     if (type.getBasicType() == EbtStruct && containsFieldWithBasicType(type, EbtAccStructNV))
3027         error(loc, "non-uniform struct contains an accelerationStructureNV:", type.getBasicTypeString().c_str(), identifier.c_str());
3028     else if (type.getBasicType() == EbtAccStructNV && type.getQualifier().storage != EvqUniform)
3029         error(loc, "accelerationStructureNV can only be used in uniform variables or function parameters:",
3030             type.getBasicTypeString().c_str(), identifier.c_str());
3031 
3032 }
3033 #endif
3034 
transparentOpaqueCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TType & type,const TString & identifier)3035 void TParseContext::transparentOpaqueCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TType& type, const TString& identifier)
3036 {
3037     if (parsingBuiltins)
3038         return;
3039 
3040     if (type.getQualifier().storage != EvqUniform)
3041         return;
3042 
3043     if (type.containsNonOpaque()) {
3044         // Vulkan doesn't allow transparent uniforms outside of blocks
3045         if (spvVersion.vulkan > 0)
3046             vulkanRemoved(loc, "non-opaque uniforms outside a block");
3047         // OpenGL wants locations on these (unless they are getting automapped)
3048         if (spvVersion.openGl > 0 && !type.getQualifier().hasLocation() && !intermediate.getAutoMapLocations())
3049             error(loc, "non-opaque uniform variables need a layout(location=L)", identifier.c_str(), "");
3050     }
3051 }
3052 
3053 //
3054 // Qualifier checks knowing the qualifier and that it is a member of a struct/block.
3055 //
memberQualifierCheck(glslang::TPublicType & publicType)3056 void TParseContext::memberQualifierCheck(glslang::TPublicType& publicType)
3057 {
3058     globalQualifierFixCheck(publicType.loc, publicType.qualifier);
3059     checkNoShaderLayouts(publicType.loc, publicType.shaderQualifiers);
3060     if (publicType.qualifier.isNonUniform()) {
3061         error(publicType.loc, "not allowed on block or structure members", "nonuniformEXT", "");
3062         publicType.qualifier.nonUniform = false;
3063     }
3064 }
3065 
3066 //
3067 // Check/fix just a full qualifier (no variables or types yet, but qualifier is complete) at global level.
3068 //
globalQualifierFixCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,TQualifier & qualifier)3069 void TParseContext::globalQualifierFixCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, TQualifier& qualifier)
3070 {
3071     bool nonuniformOkay = false;
3072 
3073     // move from parameter/unknown qualifiers to pipeline in/out qualifiers
3074     switch (qualifier.storage) {
3075     case EvqIn:
3076         profileRequires(loc, ENoProfile, 130, nullptr, "in for stage inputs");
3077         profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, "in for stage inputs");
3078         qualifier.storage = EvqVaryingIn;
3079         nonuniformOkay = true;
3080         break;
3081     case EvqOut:
3082         profileRequires(loc, ENoProfile, 130, nullptr, "out for stage outputs");
3083         profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, "out for stage outputs");
3084         qualifier.storage = EvqVaryingOut;
3085         break;
3086     case EvqInOut:
3087         qualifier.storage = EvqVaryingIn;
3088         error(loc, "cannot use 'inout' at global scope", "", "");
3089         break;
3090     case EvqGlobal:
3091     case EvqTemporary:
3092         nonuniformOkay = true;
3093         break;
3094     default:
3095         break;
3096     }
3097 
3098     if (!nonuniformOkay && qualifier.nonUniform)
3099         error(loc, "for non-parameter, can only apply to 'in' or no storage qualifier", "nonuniformEXT", "");
3100 
3101     invariantCheck(loc, qualifier);
3102 }
3103 
3104 //
3105 // Check a full qualifier and type (no variable yet) at global level.
3106 //
globalQualifierTypeCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TQualifier & qualifier,const TPublicType & publicType)3107 void TParseContext::globalQualifierTypeCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TQualifier& qualifier, const TPublicType& publicType)
3108 {
3109     if (! symbolTable.atGlobalLevel())
3110         return;
3111 
3112     if (!(publicType.userDef && publicType.userDef->getBasicType() == EbtReference)) {
3113         if (qualifier.isMemoryQualifierImageAndSSBOOnly() && ! publicType.isImage() && publicType.qualifier.storage != EvqBuffer) {
3114             error(loc, "memory qualifiers cannot be used on this type", "", "");
3115         } else if (qualifier.isMemory() && (publicType.basicType != EbtSampler) && !publicType.qualifier.isUniformOrBuffer()) {
3116             error(loc, "memory qualifiers cannot be used on this type", "", "");
3117         }
3118     }
3119 
3120     if (qualifier.storage == EvqBuffer &&
3121         publicType.basicType != EbtBlock &&
3122         !qualifier.layoutBufferReference)
3123         error(loc, "buffers can be declared only as blocks", "buffer", "");
3124 
3125     if (qualifier.storage != EvqVaryingIn && qualifier.storage != EvqVaryingOut)
3126         return;
3127 
3128     if (publicType.shaderQualifiers.blendEquation)
3129         error(loc, "can only be applied to a standalone 'out'", "blend equation", "");
3130 
3131     // now, knowing it is a shader in/out, do all the in/out semantic checks
3132 
3133     if (publicType.basicType == EbtBool && !parsingBuiltins) {
3134         error(loc, "cannot be bool", GetStorageQualifierString(qualifier.storage), "");
3135         return;
3136     }
3137 
3138     if (isTypeInt(publicType.basicType) || publicType.basicType == EbtDouble)
3139         profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, "shader input/output");
3140 
3141     if (!qualifier.flat
3142 #ifdef AMD_EXTENSIONS
3143         && !qualifier.explicitInterp
3144 #endif
3145 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
3146         && !qualifier.pervertexNV
3147 #endif
3148         ) {
3149         if (isTypeInt(publicType.basicType) ||
3150             publicType.basicType == EbtDouble ||
3151             (publicType.userDef && (publicType.userDef->containsBasicType(EbtInt8)   ||
3152                                     publicType.userDef->containsBasicType(EbtUint8)  ||
3153                                     publicType.userDef->containsBasicType(EbtInt16)  ||
3154                                     publicType.userDef->containsBasicType(EbtUint16) ||
3155                                     publicType.userDef->containsBasicType(EbtInt)    ||
3156                                     publicType.userDef->containsBasicType(EbtUint)   ||
3157                                     publicType.userDef->containsBasicType(EbtInt64)  ||
3158                                     publicType.userDef->containsBasicType(EbtUint64) ||
3159                                     publicType.userDef->containsBasicType(EbtDouble)))) {
3160             if (qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingIn && language == EShLangFragment)
3161                 error(loc, "must be qualified as flat", TType::getBasicString(publicType.basicType), GetStorageQualifierString(qualifier.storage));
3162             else if (qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingOut && language == EShLangVertex && version == 300)
3163                 error(loc, "must be qualified as flat", TType::getBasicString(publicType.basicType), GetStorageQualifierString(qualifier.storage));
3164         }
3165     }
3166 
3167     if (qualifier.patch && qualifier.isInterpolation())
3168         error(loc, "cannot use interpolation qualifiers with patch", "patch", "");
3169 
3170 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
3171     if (qualifier.perTaskNV && publicType.basicType != EbtBlock)
3172         error(loc, "taskNV variables can be declared only as blocks", "taskNV", "");
3173 #endif
3174 
3175     if (qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingIn) {
3176         switch (language) {
3177         case EShLangVertex:
3178             if (publicType.basicType == EbtStruct) {
3179                 error(loc, "cannot be a structure or array", GetStorageQualifierString(qualifier.storage), "");
3180                 return;
3181             }
3182             if (publicType.arraySizes) {
3183                 requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, "vertex input arrays");
3184                 profileRequires(loc, ENoProfile, 150, nullptr, "vertex input arrays");
3185             }
3186             if (publicType.basicType == EbtDouble)
3187                 profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 410, nullptr, "vertex-shader `double` type input");
3188             if (qualifier.isAuxiliary() || qualifier.isInterpolation() || qualifier.isMemory() || qualifier.invariant)
3189                 error(loc, "vertex input cannot be further qualified", "", "");
3190             break;
3191 
3192         case EShLangTessControl:
3193             if (qualifier.patch)
3194                 error(loc, "can only use on output in tessellation-control shader", "patch", "");
3195             break;
3196 
3197         case EShLangTessEvaluation:
3198             break;
3199 
3200         case EShLangGeometry:
3201             break;
3202 
3203         case EShLangFragment:
3204             if (publicType.userDef) {
3205                 profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, "fragment-shader struct input");
3206                 profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 150, nullptr, "fragment-shader struct input");
3207                 if (publicType.userDef->containsStructure())
3208                     requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, "fragment-shader struct input containing structure");
3209                 if (publicType.userDef->containsArray())
3210                     requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, "fragment-shader struct input containing an array");
3211             }
3212             break;
3213 
3214         case EShLangCompute:
3215             if (! symbolTable.atBuiltInLevel())
3216                 error(loc, "global storage input qualifier cannot be used in a compute shader", "in", "");
3217             break;
3218 
3219         default:
3220             break;
3221         }
3222     } else {
3223         // qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingOut
3224         switch (language) {
3225         case EShLangVertex:
3226             if (publicType.userDef) {
3227                 profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, "vertex-shader struct output");
3228                 profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 150, nullptr, "vertex-shader struct output");
3229                 if (publicType.userDef->containsStructure())
3230                     requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, "vertex-shader struct output containing structure");
3231                 if (publicType.userDef->containsArray())
3232                     requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, "vertex-shader struct output containing an array");
3233             }
3234 
3235             break;
3236 
3237         case EShLangTessControl:
3238             break;
3239 
3240         case EShLangTessEvaluation:
3241             if (qualifier.patch)
3242                 error(loc, "can only use on input in tessellation-evaluation shader", "patch", "");
3243             break;
3244 
3245         case EShLangGeometry:
3246             break;
3247 
3248         case EShLangFragment:
3249             profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, "fragment shader output");
3250             if (publicType.basicType == EbtStruct) {
3251                 error(loc, "cannot be a structure", GetStorageQualifierString(qualifier.storage), "");
3252                 return;
3253             }
3254             if (publicType.matrixRows > 0) {
3255                 error(loc, "cannot be a matrix", GetStorageQualifierString(qualifier.storage), "");
3256                 return;
3257             }
3258             if (qualifier.isAuxiliary())
3259                 error(loc, "can't use auxiliary qualifier on a fragment output", "centroid/sample/patch", "");
3260             if (qualifier.isInterpolation())
3261                 error(loc, "can't use interpolation qualifier on a fragment output", "flat/smooth/noperspective", "");
3262             if (publicType.basicType == EbtDouble || publicType.basicType == EbtInt64 || publicType.basicType == EbtUint64)
3263                 error(loc, "cannot contain a double, int64, or uint64", GetStorageQualifierString(qualifier.storage), "");
3264         break;
3265 
3266         case EShLangCompute:
3267             error(loc, "global storage output qualifier cannot be used in a compute shader", "out", "");
3268             break;
3269 
3270         default:
3271             break;
3272         }
3273     }
3274 }
3275 
3276 //
3277 // Merge characteristics of the 'src' qualifier into the 'dst'.
3278 // If there is duplication, issue error messages, unless 'force'
3279 // is specified, which means to just override default settings.
3280 //
3281 // Also, when force is false, it will be assumed that 'src' follows
3282 // 'dst', for the purpose of error checking order for versions
3283 // that require specific orderings of qualifiers.
3284 //
mergeQualifiers(const TSourceLoc & loc,TQualifier & dst,const TQualifier & src,bool force)3285 void TParseContext::mergeQualifiers(const TSourceLoc& loc, TQualifier& dst, const TQualifier& src, bool force)
3286 {
3287     // Multiple auxiliary qualifiers (mostly done later by 'individual qualifiers')
3288     if (src.isAuxiliary() && dst.isAuxiliary())
3289         error(loc, "can only have one auxiliary qualifier (centroid, patch, and sample)", "", "");
3290 
3291     // Multiple interpolation qualifiers (mostly done later by 'individual qualifiers')
3292     if (src.isInterpolation() && dst.isInterpolation())
3293 #ifdef AMD_EXTENSIONS
3294         error(loc, "can only have one interpolation qualifier (flat, smooth, noperspective, __explicitInterpAMD)", "", "");
3295 #else
3296         error(loc, "can only have one interpolation qualifier (flat, smooth, noperspective)", "", "");
3297 #endif
3298 
3299     // Ordering
3300     if (! force && ((profile != EEsProfile && version < 420) ||
3301                     (profile == EEsProfile && version < 310))
3302                 && ! extensionTurnedOn(E_GL_ARB_shading_language_420pack)) {
3303         // non-function parameters
3304         if (src.noContraction && (dst.invariant || dst.isInterpolation() || dst.isAuxiliary() || dst.storage != EvqTemporary || dst.precision != EpqNone))
3305             error(loc, "precise qualifier must appear first", "", "");
3306         if (src.invariant && (dst.isInterpolation() || dst.isAuxiliary() || dst.storage != EvqTemporary || dst.precision != EpqNone))
3307             error(loc, "invariant qualifier must appear before interpolation, storage, and precision qualifiers ", "", "");
3308         else if (src.isInterpolation() && (dst.isAuxiliary() || dst.storage != EvqTemporary || dst.precision != EpqNone))
3309             error(loc, "interpolation qualifiers must appear before storage and precision qualifiers", "", "");
3310         else if (src.isAuxiliary() && (dst.storage != EvqTemporary || dst.precision != EpqNone))
3311             error(loc, "Auxiliary qualifiers (centroid, patch, and sample) must appear before storage and precision qualifiers", "", "");
3312         else if (src.storage != EvqTemporary && (dst.precision != EpqNone))
3313             error(loc, "precision qualifier must appear as last qualifier", "", "");
3314 
3315         // function parameters
3316         if (src.noContraction && (dst.storage == EvqConst || dst.storage == EvqIn || dst.storage == EvqOut))
3317             error(loc, "precise qualifier must appear first", "", "");
3318         if (src.storage == EvqConst && (dst.storage == EvqIn || dst.storage == EvqOut))
3319             error(loc, "in/out must appear before const", "", "");
3320     }
3321 
3322     // Storage qualification
3323     if (dst.storage == EvqTemporary || dst.storage == EvqGlobal)
3324         dst.storage = src.storage;
3325     else if ((dst.storage == EvqIn  && src.storage == EvqOut) ||
3326              (dst.storage == EvqOut && src.storage == EvqIn))
3327         dst.storage = EvqInOut;
3328     else if ((dst.storage == EvqIn    && src.storage == EvqConst) ||
3329              (dst.storage == EvqConst && src.storage == EvqIn))
3330         dst.storage = EvqConstReadOnly;
3331     else if (src.storage != EvqTemporary &&
3332              src.storage != EvqGlobal)
3333         error(loc, "too many storage qualifiers", GetStorageQualifierString(src.storage), "");
3334 
3335     // Precision qualifiers
3336     if (! force && src.precision != EpqNone && dst.precision != EpqNone)
3337         error(loc, "only one precision qualifier allowed", GetPrecisionQualifierString(src.precision), "");
3338     if (dst.precision == EpqNone || (force && src.precision != EpqNone))
3339         dst.precision = src.precision;
3340 
3341     if (!force && ((src.coherent && (dst.devicecoherent || dst.queuefamilycoherent || dst.workgroupcoherent || dst.subgroupcoherent)) ||
3342                    (src.devicecoherent && (dst.coherent || dst.queuefamilycoherent || dst.workgroupcoherent || dst.subgroupcoherent)) ||
3343                    (src.queuefamilycoherent && (dst.coherent || dst.devicecoherent || dst.workgroupcoherent || dst.subgroupcoherent)) ||
3344                    (src.workgroupcoherent && (dst.coherent || dst.devicecoherent || dst.queuefamilycoherent || dst.subgroupcoherent)) ||
3345                    (src.subgroupcoherent  && (dst.coherent || dst.devicecoherent || dst.queuefamilycoherent || dst.workgroupcoherent)))) {
3346         error(loc, "only one coherent/devicecoherent/queuefamilycoherent/workgroupcoherent/subgroupcoherent qualifier allowed", GetPrecisionQualifierString(src.precision), "");
3347     }
3348     // Layout qualifiers
3349     mergeObjectLayoutQualifiers(dst, src, false);
3350 
3351     // individual qualifiers
3352     bool repeated = false;
3353     #define MERGE_SINGLETON(field) repeated |= dst.field && src.field; dst.field |= src.field;
3354     MERGE_SINGLETON(invariant);
3355     MERGE_SINGLETON(noContraction);
3356     MERGE_SINGLETON(centroid);
3357     MERGE_SINGLETON(smooth);
3358     MERGE_SINGLETON(flat);
3359     MERGE_SINGLETON(nopersp);
3360 #ifdef AMD_EXTENSIONS
3361     MERGE_SINGLETON(explicitInterp);
3362 #endif
3363 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
3364     MERGE_SINGLETON(perPrimitiveNV);
3365     MERGE_SINGLETON(perViewNV);
3366     MERGE_SINGLETON(perTaskNV);
3367 #endif
3368     MERGE_SINGLETON(patch);
3369     MERGE_SINGLETON(sample);
3370     MERGE_SINGLETON(coherent);
3371     MERGE_SINGLETON(devicecoherent);
3372     MERGE_SINGLETON(queuefamilycoherent);
3373     MERGE_SINGLETON(workgroupcoherent);
3374     MERGE_SINGLETON(subgroupcoherent);
3375     MERGE_SINGLETON(nonprivate);
3376     MERGE_SINGLETON(volatil);
3377     MERGE_SINGLETON(restrict);
3378     MERGE_SINGLETON(readonly);
3379     MERGE_SINGLETON(writeonly);
3380     MERGE_SINGLETON(specConstant);
3381     MERGE_SINGLETON(nonUniform);
3382 
3383     if (repeated)
3384         error(loc, "replicated qualifiers", "", "");
3385 }
3386 
setDefaultPrecision(const TSourceLoc & loc,TPublicType & publicType,TPrecisionQualifier qualifier)3387 void TParseContext::setDefaultPrecision(const TSourceLoc& loc, TPublicType& publicType, TPrecisionQualifier qualifier)
3388 {
3389     TBasicType basicType = publicType.basicType;
3390 
3391     if (basicType == EbtSampler) {
3392         defaultSamplerPrecision[computeSamplerTypeIndex(publicType.sampler)] = qualifier;
3393 
3394         return;  // all is well
3395     }
3396 
3397     if (basicType == EbtInt || basicType == EbtFloat) {
3398         if (publicType.isScalar()) {
3399             defaultPrecision[basicType] = qualifier;
3400             if (basicType == EbtInt) {
3401                 defaultPrecision[EbtUint] = qualifier;
3402                 precisionManager.explicitIntDefaultSeen();
3403             } else
3404                 precisionManager.explicitFloatDefaultSeen();
3405 
3406             return;  // all is well
3407         }
3408     }
3409 
3410     if (basicType == EbtAtomicUint) {
3411         if (qualifier != EpqHigh)
3412             error(loc, "can only apply highp to atomic_uint", "precision", "");
3413 
3414         return;
3415     }
3416 
3417     error(loc, "cannot apply precision statement to this type; use 'float', 'int' or a sampler type", TType::getBasicString(basicType), "");
3418 }
3419 
3420 // used to flatten the sampler type space into a single dimension
3421 // correlates with the declaration of defaultSamplerPrecision[]
computeSamplerTypeIndex(TSampler & sampler)3422 int TParseContext::computeSamplerTypeIndex(TSampler& sampler)
3423 {
3424     int arrayIndex    = sampler.arrayed ? 1 : 0;
3425     int shadowIndex   = sampler.shadow  ? 1 : 0;
3426     int externalIndex = sampler.external? 1 : 0;
3427     int imageIndex    = sampler.image   ? 1 : 0;
3428     int msIndex       = sampler.ms      ? 1 : 0;
3429 
3430     int flattened = EsdNumDims * (EbtNumTypes * (2 * (2 * (2 * (2 * arrayIndex + msIndex) + imageIndex) + shadowIndex) +
3431                                                  externalIndex) + sampler.type) + sampler.dim;
3432     assert(flattened < maxSamplerIndex);
3433 
3434     return flattened;
3435 }
3436 
getDefaultPrecision(TPublicType & publicType)3437 TPrecisionQualifier TParseContext::getDefaultPrecision(TPublicType& publicType)
3438 {
3439     if (publicType.basicType == EbtSampler)
3440         return defaultSamplerPrecision[computeSamplerTypeIndex(publicType.sampler)];
3441     else
3442         return defaultPrecision[publicType.basicType];
3443 }
3444 
precisionQualifierCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,TBasicType baseType,TQualifier & qualifier)3445 void TParseContext::precisionQualifierCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, TBasicType baseType, TQualifier& qualifier)
3446 {
3447     // Built-in symbols are allowed some ambiguous precisions, to be pinned down
3448     // later by context.
3449     if (! obeyPrecisionQualifiers() || parsingBuiltins)
3450         return;
3451 
3452     if (baseType == EbtAtomicUint && qualifier.precision != EpqNone && qualifier.precision != EpqHigh)
3453         error(loc, "atomic counters can only be highp", "atomic_uint", "");
3454 
3455     if (baseType == EbtFloat || baseType == EbtUint || baseType == EbtInt || baseType == EbtSampler || baseType == EbtAtomicUint) {
3456         if (qualifier.precision == EpqNone) {
3457             if (relaxedErrors())
3458                 warn(loc, "type requires declaration of default precision qualifier", TType::getBasicString(baseType), "substituting 'mediump'");
3459             else
3460                 error(loc, "type requires declaration of default precision qualifier", TType::getBasicString(baseType), "");
3461             qualifier.precision = EpqMedium;
3462             defaultPrecision[baseType] = EpqMedium;
3463         }
3464     } else if (qualifier.precision != EpqNone)
3465         error(loc, "type cannot have precision qualifier", TType::getBasicString(baseType), "");
3466 }
3467 
parameterTypeCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,TStorageQualifier qualifier,const TType & type)3468 void TParseContext::parameterTypeCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, TStorageQualifier qualifier, const TType& type)
3469 {
3470     if ((qualifier == EvqOut || qualifier == EvqInOut) && type.isOpaque())
3471         error(loc, "samplers and atomic_uints cannot be output parameters", type.getBasicTypeString().c_str(), "");
3472 
3473     if (!parsingBuiltins && type.containsBasicType(EbtFloat16))
3474         requireFloat16Arithmetic(loc, type.getBasicTypeString().c_str(), "float16 types can only be in uniform block or buffer storage");
3475     if (!parsingBuiltins && type.contains16BitInt())
3476         requireInt16Arithmetic(loc, type.getBasicTypeString().c_str(), "(u)int16 types can only be in uniform block or buffer storage");
3477     if (!parsingBuiltins && type.contains8BitInt())
3478         requireInt8Arithmetic(loc, type.getBasicTypeString().c_str(), "(u)int8 types can only be in uniform block or buffer storage");
3479 }
3480 
containsFieldWithBasicType(const TType & type,TBasicType basicType)3481 bool TParseContext::containsFieldWithBasicType(const TType& type, TBasicType basicType)
3482 {
3483     if (type.getBasicType() == basicType)
3484         return true;
3485 
3486     if (type.getBasicType() == EbtStruct) {
3487         const TTypeList& structure = *type.getStruct();
3488         for (unsigned int i = 0; i < structure.size(); ++i) {
3489             if (containsFieldWithBasicType(*structure[i].type, basicType))
3490                 return true;
3491         }
3492     }
3493 
3494     return false;
3495 }
3496 
3497 //
3498 // Do size checking for an array type's size.
3499 //
arraySizeCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,TIntermTyped * expr,TArraySize & sizePair)3500 void TParseContext::arraySizeCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, TIntermTyped* expr, TArraySize& sizePair)
3501 {
3502     bool isConst = false;
3503     sizePair.node = nullptr;
3504 
3505     int size = 1;
3506 
3507     TIntermConstantUnion* constant = expr->getAsConstantUnion();
3508     if (constant) {
3509         // handle true (non-specialization) constant
3510         size = constant->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
3511         isConst = true;
3512     } else {
3513         // see if it's a specialization constant instead
3514         if (expr->getQualifier().isSpecConstant()) {
3515             isConst = true;
3516             sizePair.node = expr;
3517             TIntermSymbol* symbol = expr->getAsSymbolNode();
3518             if (symbol && symbol->getConstArray().size() > 0)
3519                 size = symbol->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
3520         }
3521     }
3522 
3523     sizePair.size = size;
3524 
3525     if (! isConst || (expr->getBasicType() != EbtInt && expr->getBasicType() != EbtUint)) {
3526         error(loc, "array size must be a constant integer expression", "", "");
3527         return;
3528     }
3529 
3530     if (size <= 0) {
3531         error(loc, "array size must be a positive integer", "", "");
3532         return;
3533     }
3534 }
3535 
3536 //
3537 // See if this qualifier can be an array.
3538 //
3539 // Returns true if there is an error.
3540 //
arrayQualifierError(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TQualifier & qualifier)3541 bool TParseContext::arrayQualifierError(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TQualifier& qualifier)
3542 {
3543     if (qualifier.storage == EvqConst) {
3544         profileRequires(loc, ENoProfile, 120, E_GL_3DL_array_objects, "const array");
3545         profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, "const array");
3546     }
3547 
3548     if (qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingIn && language == EShLangVertex) {
3549         requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, "vertex input arrays");
3550         profileRequires(loc, ENoProfile, 150, nullptr, "vertex input arrays");
3551     }
3552 
3553     return false;
3554 }
3555 
3556 //
3557 // See if this qualifier and type combination can be an array.
3558 // Assumes arrayQualifierError() was also called to catch the type-invariant tests.
3559 //
3560 // Returns true if there is an error.
3561 //
arrayError(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TType & type)3562 bool TParseContext::arrayError(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TType& type)
3563 {
3564     if (type.getQualifier().storage == EvqVaryingOut && language == EShLangVertex) {
3565         if (type.isArrayOfArrays())
3566             requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, "vertex-shader array-of-array output");
3567         else if (type.isStruct())
3568             requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, "vertex-shader array-of-struct output");
3569     }
3570     if (type.getQualifier().storage == EvqVaryingIn && language == EShLangFragment) {
3571         if (type.isArrayOfArrays())
3572             requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, "fragment-shader array-of-array input");
3573         else if (type.isStruct())
3574             requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, "fragment-shader array-of-struct input");
3575     }
3576     if (type.getQualifier().storage == EvqVaryingOut && language == EShLangFragment) {
3577         if (type.isArrayOfArrays())
3578             requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, "fragment-shader array-of-array output");
3579     }
3580 
3581     return false;
3582 }
3583 
3584 //
3585 // Require array to be completely sized
3586 //
arraySizeRequiredCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TArraySizes & arraySizes)3587 void TParseContext::arraySizeRequiredCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TArraySizes& arraySizes)
3588 {
3589     if (arraySizes.hasUnsized())
3590         error(loc, "array size required", "", "");
3591 }
3592 
structArrayCheck(const TSourceLoc &,const TType & type)3593 void TParseContext::structArrayCheck(const TSourceLoc& /*loc*/, const TType& type)
3594 {
3595     const TTypeList& structure = *type.getStruct();
3596     for (int m = 0; m < (int)structure.size(); ++m) {
3597         const TType& member = *structure[m].type;
3598         if (member.isArray())
3599             arraySizeRequiredCheck(structure[m].loc, *member.getArraySizes());
3600     }
3601 }
3602 
arraySizesCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TQualifier & qualifier,TArraySizes * arraySizes,const TIntermTyped * initializer,bool lastMember)3603 void TParseContext::arraySizesCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TQualifier& qualifier, TArraySizes* arraySizes,
3604     const TIntermTyped* initializer, bool lastMember)
3605 {
3606     assert(arraySizes);
3607 
3608     // always allow special built-in ins/outs sized to topologies
3609     if (parsingBuiltins)
3610         return;
3611 
3612     // initializer must be a sized array, in which case
3613     // allow the initializer to set any unknown array sizes
3614     if (initializer != nullptr) {
3615         if (initializer->getType().isUnsizedArray())
3616             error(loc, "array initializer must be sized", "[]", "");
3617         return;
3618     }
3619 
3620     // No environment allows any non-outer-dimension to be implicitly sized
3621     if (arraySizes->isInnerUnsized()) {
3622         error(loc, "only outermost dimension of an array of arrays can be implicitly sized", "[]", "");
3623         arraySizes->clearInnerUnsized();
3624     }
3625 
3626     if (arraySizes->isInnerSpecialization())
3627         error(loc, "only outermost dimension of an array of arrays can be a specialization constant", "[]", "");
3628 
3629     // desktop always allows outer-dimension-unsized variable arrays,
3630     if (profile != EEsProfile)
3631         return;
3632 
3633     // for ES, if size isn't coming from an initializer, it has to be explicitly declared now,
3634     // with very few exceptions
3635 
3636     // last member of ssbo block exception:
3637     if (qualifier.storage == EvqBuffer && lastMember)
3638         return;
3639 
3640     // implicitly-sized io exceptions:
3641     switch (language) {
3642     case EShLangGeometry:
3643         if (qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingIn)
3644             if ((profile == EEsProfile && version >= 320) ||
3645                 extensionsTurnedOn(Num_AEP_geometry_shader, AEP_geometry_shader))
3646                 return;
3647         break;
3648     case EShLangTessControl:
3649         if ( qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingIn ||
3650             (qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingOut && ! qualifier.patch))
3651             if ((profile == EEsProfile && version >= 320) ||
3652                 extensionsTurnedOn(Num_AEP_tessellation_shader, AEP_tessellation_shader))
3653                 return;
3654         break;
3655     case EShLangTessEvaluation:
3656         if ((qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingIn && ! qualifier.patch) ||
3657              qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingOut)
3658             if ((profile == EEsProfile && version >= 320) ||
3659                 extensionsTurnedOn(Num_AEP_tessellation_shader, AEP_tessellation_shader))
3660                 return;
3661         break;
3662 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
3663     case EShLangMeshNV:
3664         if (qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingOut)
3665             if ((profile == EEsProfile && version >= 320) ||
3666                 extensionTurnedOn(E_GL_NV_mesh_shader))
3667                 return;
3668         break;
3669 #endif
3670     default:
3671         break;
3672     }
3673 
3674     arraySizeRequiredCheck(loc, *arraySizes);
3675 }
3676 
arrayOfArrayVersionCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TArraySizes * sizes)3677 void TParseContext::arrayOfArrayVersionCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TArraySizes* sizes)
3678 {
3679     if (sizes == nullptr || sizes->getNumDims() == 1)
3680         return;
3681 
3682     const char* feature = "arrays of arrays";
3683 
3684     requireProfile(loc, EEsProfile | ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, feature);
3685     profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 310, nullptr, feature);
3686     profileRequires(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, 430, nullptr, feature);
3687 }
3688 
3689 //
3690 // Do all the semantic checking for declaring or redeclaring an array, with and
3691 // without a size, and make the right changes to the symbol table.
3692 //
declareArray(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TString & identifier,const TType & type,TSymbol * & symbol)3693 void TParseContext::declareArray(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TString& identifier, const TType& type, TSymbol*& symbol)
3694 {
3695     if (symbol == nullptr) {
3696         bool currentScope;
3697         symbol = symbolTable.find(identifier, nullptr, &currentScope);
3698 
3699         if (symbol && builtInName(identifier) && ! symbolTable.atBuiltInLevel()) {
3700             // bad shader (errors already reported) trying to redeclare a built-in name as an array
3701             symbol = nullptr;
3702             return;
3703         }
3704         if (symbol == nullptr || ! currentScope) {
3705             //
3706             // Successfully process a new definition.
3707             // (Redeclarations have to take place at the same scope; otherwise they are hiding declarations)
3708             //
3709             symbol = new TVariable(&identifier, type);
3710             symbolTable.insert(*symbol);
3711             if (symbolTable.atGlobalLevel())
3712                 trackLinkage(*symbol);
3713 
3714             if (! symbolTable.atBuiltInLevel()) {
3715                 if (isIoResizeArray(type)) {
3716                     ioArraySymbolResizeList.push_back(symbol);
3717                     checkIoArraysConsistency(loc, true, type.getQualifier().isPerPrimitive());
3718                 } else
3719                     fixIoArraySize(loc, symbol->getWritableType());
3720             }
3721 
3722             return;
3723         }
3724         if (symbol->getAsAnonMember()) {
3725             error(loc, "cannot redeclare a user-block member array", identifier.c_str(), "");
3726             symbol = nullptr;
3727             return;
3728         }
3729     }
3730 
3731     //
3732     // Process a redeclaration.
3733     //
3734 
3735     if (symbol == nullptr) {
3736         error(loc, "array variable name expected", identifier.c_str(), "");
3737         return;
3738     }
3739 
3740     // redeclareBuiltinVariable() should have already done the copyUp()
3741     TType& existingType = symbol->getWritableType();
3742 
3743     if (! existingType.isArray()) {
3744         error(loc, "redeclaring non-array as array", identifier.c_str(), "");
3745         return;
3746     }
3747 
3748     if (! existingType.sameElementType(type)) {
3749         error(loc, "redeclaration of array with a different element type", identifier.c_str(), "");
3750         return;
3751     }
3752 
3753     if (! existingType.sameInnerArrayness(type)) {
3754         error(loc, "redeclaration of array with a different array dimensions or sizes", identifier.c_str(), "");
3755         return;
3756     }
3757 
3758     if (existingType.isSizedArray()) {
3759         // be more leniant for input arrays to geometry shaders and tessellation control outputs, where the redeclaration is the same size
3760         if (! (isIoResizeArray(type) && existingType.getOuterArraySize() == type.getOuterArraySize()))
3761             error(loc, "redeclaration of array with size", identifier.c_str(), "");
3762         return;
3763     }
3764 
3765     arrayLimitCheck(loc, identifier, type.getOuterArraySize());
3766 
3767     existingType.updateArraySizes(type);
3768 
3769     if (isIoResizeArray(type))
3770         checkIoArraysConsistency(loc, false, type.getQualifier().isPerPrimitive());
3771 }
3772 
3773 // Policy and error check for needing a runtime sized array.
checkRuntimeSizable(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TIntermTyped & base)3774 void TParseContext::checkRuntimeSizable(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TIntermTyped& base)
3775 {
3776     // runtime length implies runtime sizeable, so no problem
3777     if (isRuntimeLength(base))
3778         return;
3779 
3780     // Check for last member of a bufferreference type, which is runtime sizeable
3781     // but doesn't support runtime length
3782     if (base.getType().getQualifier().storage == EvqBuffer) {
3783         const TIntermBinary* binary = base.getAsBinaryNode();
3784         if (binary != nullptr &&
3785             binary->getOp() == EOpIndexDirectStruct &&
3786             binary->getLeft()->getBasicType() == EbtReference) {
3787 
3788             const int index = binary->getRight()->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
3789             const int memberCount = (int)binary->getLeft()->getType().getReferentType()->getStruct()->size();
3790             if (index == memberCount - 1)
3791                 return;
3792         }
3793     }
3794 
3795     // check for additional things allowed by GL_EXT_nonuniform_qualifier
3796     if (base.getBasicType() == EbtSampler ||
3797             (base.getBasicType() == EbtBlock && base.getType().getQualifier().isUniformOrBuffer()))
3798         requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_EXT_nonuniform_qualifier, "variable index");
3799     else
3800         error(loc, "", "[", "array must be redeclared with a size before being indexed with a variable");
3801 }
3802 
3803 // Policy decision for whether a run-time .length() is allowed.
isRuntimeLength(const TIntermTyped & base) const3804 bool TParseContext::isRuntimeLength(const TIntermTyped& base) const
3805 {
3806     if (base.getType().getQualifier().storage == EvqBuffer) {
3807         // in a buffer block
3808         const TIntermBinary* binary = base.getAsBinaryNode();
3809         if (binary != nullptr && binary->getOp() == EOpIndexDirectStruct) {
3810             // is it the last member?
3811             const int index = binary->getRight()->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
3812 
3813             if (binary->getLeft()->getBasicType() == EbtReference)
3814                 return false;
3815 
3816             const int memberCount = (int)binary->getLeft()->getType().getStruct()->size();
3817             if (index == memberCount - 1)
3818                 return true;
3819         }
3820     }
3821 
3822     return false;
3823 }
3824 
3825 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
3826 // Fix mesh view output array dimension
resizeMeshViewDimension(const TSourceLoc & loc,TType & type)3827 void TParseContext::resizeMeshViewDimension(const TSourceLoc& loc, TType& type)
3828 {
3829     // see if member is a per-view attribute
3830     if (type.getQualifier().isPerView()) {
3831         // since we don't have the maxMeshViewCountNV set during parsing builtins, we hardcode the value
3832         int maxViewCount = parsingBuiltins ? 4 : resources.maxMeshViewCountNV;
3833 
3834         if (! type.isArray()) {
3835             error(loc, "requires an view array dimension", "perviewNV", "");
3836         }
3837         else if (!type.isUnsizedArray() && type.getOuterArraySize() != maxViewCount) {
3838             error(loc, "mesh view output array size must be gl_MaxMeshViewCountNV or implicitly sized", "[]", "");
3839         }
3840         else if (type.isUnsizedArray()) {
3841             type.changeOuterArraySize(maxViewCount);
3842         }
3843     }
3844 }
3845 #endif
3846 
3847 // Returns true if the first argument to the #line directive is the line number for the next line.
3848 //
3849 // Desktop, pre-version 3.30:  "After processing this directive
3850 // (including its new-line), the implementation will behave as if it is compiling at line number line+1 and
3851 // source string number source-string-number."
3852 //
3853 // Desktop, version 3.30 and later, and ES:  "After processing this directive
3854 // (including its new-line), the implementation will behave as if it is compiling at line number line and
3855 // source string number source-string-number.
lineDirectiveShouldSetNextLine() const3856 bool TParseContext::lineDirectiveShouldSetNextLine() const
3857 {
3858     return profile == EEsProfile || version >= 330;
3859 }
3860 
3861 //
3862 // Enforce non-initializer type/qualifier rules.
3863 //
nonInitConstCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,TString & identifier,TType & type)3864 void TParseContext::nonInitConstCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, TString& identifier, TType& type)
3865 {
3866     //
3867     // Make the qualifier make sense, given that there is not an initializer.
3868     //
3869     if (type.getQualifier().storage == EvqConst ||
3870         type.getQualifier().storage == EvqConstReadOnly) {
3871         type.getQualifier().makeTemporary();
3872         error(loc, "variables with qualifier 'const' must be initialized", identifier.c_str(), "");
3873     }
3874 }
3875 
3876 //
3877 // See if the identifier is a built-in symbol that can be redeclared, and if so,
3878 // copy the symbol table's read-only built-in variable to the current
3879 // global level, where it can be modified based on the passed in type.
3880 //
3881 // Returns nullptr if no redeclaration took place; meaning a normal declaration still
3882 // needs to occur for it, not necessarily an error.
3883 //
3884 // Returns a redeclared and type-modified variable if a redeclarated occurred.
3885 //
redeclareBuiltinVariable(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TString & identifier,const TQualifier & qualifier,const TShaderQualifiers & publicType)3886 TSymbol* TParseContext::redeclareBuiltinVariable(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TString& identifier,
3887                                                  const TQualifier& qualifier, const TShaderQualifiers& publicType)
3888 {
3889     if (! builtInName(identifier) || symbolTable.atBuiltInLevel() || ! symbolTable.atGlobalLevel())
3890         return nullptr;
3891 
3892     bool nonEsRedecls = (profile != EEsProfile && (version >= 130 || identifier == "gl_TexCoord"));
3893     bool    esRedecls = (profile == EEsProfile &&
3894                          (version >= 320 || extensionsTurnedOn(Num_AEP_shader_io_blocks, AEP_shader_io_blocks)));
3895     if (! esRedecls && ! nonEsRedecls)
3896         return nullptr;
3897 
3898     // Special case when using GL_ARB_separate_shader_objects
3899     bool ssoPre150 = false;  // means the only reason this variable is redeclared is due to this combination
3900     if (profile != EEsProfile && version <= 140 && extensionTurnedOn(E_GL_ARB_separate_shader_objects)) {
3901         if (identifier == "gl_Position"     ||
3902             identifier == "gl_PointSize"    ||
3903             identifier == "gl_ClipVertex"   ||
3904             identifier == "gl_FogFragCoord")
3905             ssoPre150 = true;
3906     }
3907 
3908     // Potentially redeclaring a built-in variable...
3909 
3910     if (ssoPre150 ||
3911         (identifier == "gl_FragDepth"           && ((nonEsRedecls && version >= 420) || esRedecls)) ||
3912         (identifier == "gl_FragCoord"           && ((nonEsRedecls && version >= 150) || esRedecls)) ||
3913          identifier == "gl_ClipDistance"                                                            ||
3914          identifier == "gl_CullDistance"                                                            ||
3915          identifier == "gl_FrontColor"                                                              ||
3916          identifier == "gl_BackColor"                                                               ||
3917          identifier == "gl_FrontSecondaryColor"                                                     ||
3918          identifier == "gl_BackSecondaryColor"                                                      ||
3919          identifier == "gl_SecondaryColor"                                                          ||
3920         (identifier == "gl_Color"               && language == EShLangFragment)                     ||
3921         (identifier == "gl_FragStencilRefARB"   && (nonEsRedecls && version >= 140)
3922                                                 && language == EShLangFragment)                     ||
3923 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
3924          identifier == "gl_SampleMask"                                                              ||
3925          identifier == "gl_Layer"                                                                   ||
3926 #endif
3927          identifier == "gl_TexCoord") {
3928 
3929         // Find the existing symbol, if any.
3930         bool builtIn;
3931         TSymbol* symbol = symbolTable.find(identifier, &builtIn);
3932 
3933         // If the symbol was not found, this must be a version/profile/stage
3934         // that doesn't have it.
3935         if (! symbol)
3936             return nullptr;
3937 
3938         // If it wasn't at a built-in level, then it's already been redeclared;
3939         // that is, this is a redeclaration of a redeclaration; reuse that initial
3940         // redeclaration.  Otherwise, make the new one.
3941         if (builtIn)
3942             makeEditable(symbol);
3943 
3944         // Now, modify the type of the copy, as per the type of the current redeclaration.
3945 
3946         TQualifier& symbolQualifier = symbol->getWritableType().getQualifier();
3947         if (ssoPre150) {
3948             if (intermediate.inIoAccessed(identifier))
3949                 error(loc, "cannot redeclare after use", identifier.c_str(), "");
3950             if (qualifier.hasLayout())
3951                 error(loc, "cannot apply layout qualifier to", "redeclaration", symbol->getName().c_str());
3952             if (qualifier.isMemory() || qualifier.isAuxiliary() || (language == EShLangVertex   && qualifier.storage != EvqVaryingOut) ||
3953                                                                    (language == EShLangFragment && qualifier.storage != EvqVaryingIn))
3954                 error(loc, "cannot change storage, memory, or auxiliary qualification of", "redeclaration", symbol->getName().c_str());
3955             if (! qualifier.smooth)
3956                 error(loc, "cannot change interpolation qualification of", "redeclaration", symbol->getName().c_str());
3957         } else if (identifier == "gl_FrontColor"          ||
3958                    identifier == "gl_BackColor"           ||
3959                    identifier == "gl_FrontSecondaryColor" ||
3960                    identifier == "gl_BackSecondaryColor"  ||
3961                    identifier == "gl_SecondaryColor"      ||
3962                    identifier == "gl_Color") {
3963             symbolQualifier.flat = qualifier.flat;
3964             symbolQualifier.smooth = qualifier.smooth;
3965             symbolQualifier.nopersp = qualifier.nopersp;
3966             if (qualifier.hasLayout())
3967                 error(loc, "cannot apply layout qualifier to", "redeclaration", symbol->getName().c_str());
3968             if (qualifier.isMemory() || qualifier.isAuxiliary() || symbol->getType().getQualifier().storage != qualifier.storage)
3969                 error(loc, "cannot change storage, memory, or auxiliary qualification of", "redeclaration", symbol->getName().c_str());
3970         } else if (identifier == "gl_TexCoord"     ||
3971                    identifier == "gl_ClipDistance" ||
3972                    identifier == "gl_CullDistance") {
3973             if (qualifier.hasLayout() || qualifier.isMemory() || qualifier.isAuxiliary() ||
3974                 qualifier.nopersp != symbolQualifier.nopersp || qualifier.flat != symbolQualifier.flat ||
3975                 symbolQualifier.storage != qualifier.storage)
3976                 error(loc, "cannot change qualification of", "redeclaration", symbol->getName().c_str());
3977         } else if (identifier == "gl_FragCoord") {
3978             if (intermediate.inIoAccessed("gl_FragCoord"))
3979                 error(loc, "cannot redeclare after use", "gl_FragCoord", "");
3980             if (qualifier.nopersp != symbolQualifier.nopersp || qualifier.flat != symbolQualifier.flat ||
3981                 qualifier.isMemory() || qualifier.isAuxiliary())
3982                 error(loc, "can only change layout qualification of", "redeclaration", symbol->getName().c_str());
3983             if (qualifier.storage != EvqVaryingIn)
3984                 error(loc, "cannot change input storage qualification of", "redeclaration", symbol->getName().c_str());
3985             if (! builtIn && (publicType.pixelCenterInteger != intermediate.getPixelCenterInteger() ||
3986                               publicType.originUpperLeft != intermediate.getOriginUpperLeft()))
3987                 error(loc, "cannot redeclare with different qualification:", "redeclaration", symbol->getName().c_str());
3988             if (publicType.pixelCenterInteger)
3989                 intermediate.setPixelCenterInteger();
3990             if (publicType.originUpperLeft)
3991                 intermediate.setOriginUpperLeft();
3992         } else if (identifier == "gl_FragDepth") {
3993             if (qualifier.nopersp != symbolQualifier.nopersp || qualifier.flat != symbolQualifier.flat ||
3994                 qualifier.isMemory() || qualifier.isAuxiliary())
3995                 error(loc, "can only change layout qualification of", "redeclaration", symbol->getName().c_str());
3996             if (qualifier.storage != EvqVaryingOut)
3997                 error(loc, "cannot change output storage qualification of", "redeclaration", symbol->getName().c_str());
3998             if (publicType.layoutDepth != EldNone) {
3999                 if (intermediate.inIoAccessed("gl_FragDepth"))
4000                     error(loc, "cannot redeclare after use", "gl_FragDepth", "");
4001                 if (! intermediate.setDepth(publicType.layoutDepth))
4002                     error(loc, "all redeclarations must use the same depth layout on", "redeclaration", symbol->getName().c_str());
4003             }
4004         }
4005         else if (identifier == "gl_FragStencilRefARB") {
4006             if (qualifier.hasLayout())
4007                 error(loc, "cannot apply layout qualifier to", "redeclaration", symbol->getName().c_str());
4008             if (qualifier.storage != EvqVaryingOut)
4009                 error(loc, "cannot change output storage qualification of", "redeclaration", symbol->getName().c_str());
4010         }
4011 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
4012         else if (identifier == "gl_SampleMask") {
4013             if (!publicType.layoutOverrideCoverage) {
4014                 error(loc, "redeclaration only allowed for override_coverage layout", "redeclaration", symbol->getName().c_str());
4015             }
4016             intermediate.setLayoutOverrideCoverage();
4017         }
4018         else if (identifier == "gl_Layer") {
4019             if (!qualifier.layoutViewportRelative && qualifier.layoutSecondaryViewportRelativeOffset == -2048)
4020                 error(loc, "redeclaration only allowed for viewport_relative or secondary_view_offset layout", "redeclaration", symbol->getName().c_str());
4021             symbolQualifier.layoutViewportRelative = qualifier.layoutViewportRelative;
4022             symbolQualifier.layoutSecondaryViewportRelativeOffset = qualifier.layoutSecondaryViewportRelativeOffset;
4023         }
4024 #endif
4025 
4026         // TODO: semantics quality: separate smooth from nothing declared, then use IsInterpolation for several tests above
4027 
4028         return symbol;
4029     }
4030 
4031     return nullptr;
4032 }
4033 
4034 //
4035 // Either redeclare the requested block, or give an error message why it can't be done.
4036 //
4037 // TODO: functionality: explicitly sizing members of redeclared blocks is not giving them an explicit size
redeclareBuiltinBlock(const TSourceLoc & loc,TTypeList & newTypeList,const TString & blockName,const TString * instanceName,TArraySizes * arraySizes)4038 void TParseContext::redeclareBuiltinBlock(const TSourceLoc& loc, TTypeList& newTypeList, const TString& blockName,
4039     const TString* instanceName, TArraySizes* arraySizes)
4040 {
4041     const char* feature = "built-in block redeclaration";
4042     profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 320, Num_AEP_shader_io_blocks, AEP_shader_io_blocks, feature);
4043     profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 410, E_GL_ARB_separate_shader_objects, feature);
4044 
4045     if (blockName != "gl_PerVertex" && blockName != "gl_PerFragment"
4046 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
4047         && blockName != "gl_MeshPerVertexNV" && blockName != "gl_MeshPerPrimitiveNV"
4048 #endif
4049        )
4050     {
4051         error(loc, "cannot redeclare block: ", "block declaration", blockName.c_str());
4052         return;
4053     }
4054 
4055     // Redeclaring a built-in block...
4056 
4057     if (instanceName && ! builtInName(*instanceName)) {
4058         error(loc, "cannot redeclare a built-in block with a user name", instanceName->c_str(), "");
4059         return;
4060     }
4061 
4062     // Blocks with instance names are easy to find, lookup the instance name,
4063     // Anonymous blocks need to be found via a member.
4064     bool builtIn;
4065     TSymbol* block;
4066     if (instanceName)
4067         block = symbolTable.find(*instanceName, &builtIn);
4068     else
4069         block = symbolTable.find(newTypeList.front().type->getFieldName(), &builtIn);
4070 
4071     // If the block was not found, this must be a version/profile/stage
4072     // that doesn't have it, or the instance name is wrong.
4073     const char* errorName = instanceName ? instanceName->c_str() : newTypeList.front().type->getFieldName().c_str();
4074     if (! block) {
4075         error(loc, "no declaration found for redeclaration", errorName, "");
4076         return;
4077     }
4078     // Built-in blocks cannot be redeclared more than once, which if happened,
4079     // we'd be finding the already redeclared one here, rather than the built in.
4080     if (! builtIn) {
4081         error(loc, "can only redeclare a built-in block once, and before any use", blockName.c_str(), "");
4082         return;
4083     }
4084 
4085     // Copy the block to make a writable version, to insert into the block table after editing.
4086     block = symbolTable.copyUpDeferredInsert(block);
4087 
4088     if (block->getType().getBasicType() != EbtBlock) {
4089         error(loc, "cannot redeclare a non block as a block", errorName, "");
4090         return;
4091     }
4092 
4093     // Fix XFB stuff up, it applies to the order of the redeclaration, not
4094     // the order of the original members.
4095     if (currentBlockQualifier.storage == EvqVaryingOut && globalOutputDefaults.hasXfbBuffer()) {
4096         if (!currentBlockQualifier.hasXfbBuffer())
4097             currentBlockQualifier.layoutXfbBuffer = globalOutputDefaults.layoutXfbBuffer;
4098         if (!currentBlockQualifier.hasStream())
4099             currentBlockQualifier.layoutStream = globalOutputDefaults.layoutStream;
4100         fixXfbOffsets(currentBlockQualifier, newTypeList);
4101     }
4102 
4103     // Edit and error check the container against the redeclaration
4104     //  - remove unused members
4105     //  - ensure remaining qualifiers/types match
4106 
4107     TType& type = block->getWritableType();
4108 
4109 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
4110     // if gl_PerVertex is redeclared for the purpose of passing through "gl_Position"
4111     // for passthrough purpose, the redeclared block should have the same qualifers as
4112     // the current one
4113     if (currentBlockQualifier.layoutPassthrough) {
4114         type.getQualifier().layoutPassthrough = currentBlockQualifier.layoutPassthrough;
4115         type.getQualifier().storage = currentBlockQualifier.storage;
4116         type.getQualifier().layoutStream = currentBlockQualifier.layoutStream;
4117         type.getQualifier().layoutXfbBuffer = currentBlockQualifier.layoutXfbBuffer;
4118     }
4119 #endif
4120 
4121     TTypeList::iterator member = type.getWritableStruct()->begin();
4122     size_t numOriginalMembersFound = 0;
4123     while (member != type.getStruct()->end()) {
4124         // look for match
4125         bool found = false;
4126         TTypeList::const_iterator newMember;
4127         TSourceLoc memberLoc;
4128         memberLoc.init();
4129         for (newMember = newTypeList.begin(); newMember != newTypeList.end(); ++newMember) {
4130             if (member->type->getFieldName() == newMember->type->getFieldName()) {
4131                 found = true;
4132                 memberLoc = newMember->loc;
4133                 break;
4134             }
4135         }
4136 
4137         if (found) {
4138             ++numOriginalMembersFound;
4139             // - ensure match between redeclared members' types
4140             // - check for things that can't be changed
4141             // - update things that can be changed
4142             TType& oldType = *member->type;
4143             const TType& newType = *newMember->type;
4144             if (! newType.sameElementType(oldType))
4145                 error(memberLoc, "cannot redeclare block member with a different type", member->type->getFieldName().c_str(), "");
4146             if (oldType.isArray() != newType.isArray())
4147                 error(memberLoc, "cannot change arrayness of redeclared block member", member->type->getFieldName().c_str(), "");
4148             else if (! oldType.getQualifier().isPerView() && ! oldType.sameArrayness(newType) && oldType.isSizedArray())
4149                 error(memberLoc, "cannot change array size of redeclared block member", member->type->getFieldName().c_str(), "");
4150             else if (! oldType.getQualifier().isPerView() && newType.isArray())
4151                 arrayLimitCheck(loc, member->type->getFieldName(), newType.getOuterArraySize());
4152 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
4153             if (oldType.getQualifier().isPerView() && ! newType.getQualifier().isPerView())
4154                 error(memberLoc, "missing perviewNV qualifier to redeclared block member", member->type->getFieldName().c_str(), "");
4155             else if (! oldType.getQualifier().isPerView() && newType.getQualifier().isPerView())
4156                 error(memberLoc, "cannot add perviewNV qualifier to redeclared block member", member->type->getFieldName().c_str(), "");
4157             else if (newType.getQualifier().isPerView()) {
4158                 if (oldType.getArraySizes()->getNumDims() != newType.getArraySizes()->getNumDims())
4159                     error(memberLoc, "cannot change arrayness of redeclared block member", member->type->getFieldName().c_str(), "");
4160                 else if (! newType.isUnsizedArray() && newType.getOuterArraySize() != resources.maxMeshViewCountNV)
4161                     error(loc, "mesh view output array size must be gl_MaxMeshViewCountNV or implicitly sized", "[]", "");
4162                 else if (newType.getArraySizes()->getNumDims() == 2) {
4163                     int innerDimSize = newType.getArraySizes()->getDimSize(1);
4164                     arrayLimitCheck(memberLoc, member->type->getFieldName(), innerDimSize);
4165                     oldType.getArraySizes()->setDimSize(1, innerDimSize);
4166                 }
4167             }
4168             if (oldType.getQualifier().isPerPrimitive() && ! newType.getQualifier().isPerPrimitive())
4169                 error(memberLoc, "missing perprimitiveNV qualifier to redeclared block member", member->type->getFieldName().c_str(), "");
4170             else if (! oldType.getQualifier().isPerPrimitive() && newType.getQualifier().isPerPrimitive())
4171                 error(memberLoc, "cannot add perprimitiveNV qualifier to redeclared block member", member->type->getFieldName().c_str(), "");
4172 #endif
4173             if (newType.getQualifier().isMemory())
4174                 error(memberLoc, "cannot add memory qualifier to redeclared block member", member->type->getFieldName().c_str(), "");
4175             if (newType.getQualifier().hasNonXfbLayout())
4176                 error(memberLoc, "cannot add non-XFB layout to redeclared block member", member->type->getFieldName().c_str(), "");
4177             if (newType.getQualifier().patch)
4178                 error(memberLoc, "cannot add patch to redeclared block member", member->type->getFieldName().c_str(), "");
4179             if (newType.getQualifier().hasXfbBuffer() &&
4180                 newType.getQualifier().layoutXfbBuffer != currentBlockQualifier.layoutXfbBuffer)
4181                 error(memberLoc, "member cannot contradict block (or what block inherited from global)", "xfb_buffer", "");
4182             if (newType.getQualifier().hasStream() &&
4183                 newType.getQualifier().layoutStream != currentBlockQualifier.layoutStream)
4184                 error(memberLoc, "member cannot contradict block (or what block inherited from global)", "xfb_stream", "");
4185             oldType.getQualifier().centroid = newType.getQualifier().centroid;
4186             oldType.getQualifier().sample = newType.getQualifier().sample;
4187             oldType.getQualifier().invariant = newType.getQualifier().invariant;
4188             oldType.getQualifier().noContraction = newType.getQualifier().noContraction;
4189             oldType.getQualifier().smooth = newType.getQualifier().smooth;
4190             oldType.getQualifier().flat = newType.getQualifier().flat;
4191             oldType.getQualifier().nopersp = newType.getQualifier().nopersp;
4192             oldType.getQualifier().layoutXfbOffset = newType.getQualifier().layoutXfbOffset;
4193             oldType.getQualifier().layoutXfbBuffer = newType.getQualifier().layoutXfbBuffer;
4194             oldType.getQualifier().layoutXfbStride = newType.getQualifier().layoutXfbStride;
4195             if (oldType.getQualifier().layoutXfbOffset != TQualifier::layoutXfbBufferEnd) {
4196                 // If any member has an xfb_offset, then the block's xfb_buffer inherents current xfb_buffer,
4197                 // and for xfb processing, the member needs it as well, along with xfb_stride.
4198                 type.getQualifier().layoutXfbBuffer = currentBlockQualifier.layoutXfbBuffer;
4199                 oldType.getQualifier().layoutXfbBuffer = currentBlockQualifier.layoutXfbBuffer;
4200             }
4201             if (oldType.isUnsizedArray() && newType.isSizedArray())
4202                 oldType.changeOuterArraySize(newType.getOuterArraySize());
4203 
4204             //  check and process the member's type, which will include managing xfb information
4205             layoutTypeCheck(loc, oldType);
4206 
4207             // go to next member
4208             ++member;
4209         } else {
4210             // For missing members of anonymous blocks that have been redeclared,
4211             // hide the original (shared) declaration.
4212             // Instance-named blocks can just have the member removed.
4213             if (instanceName)
4214                 member = type.getWritableStruct()->erase(member);
4215             else {
4216                 member->type->hideMember();
4217                 ++member;
4218             }
4219         }
4220     }
4221 
4222     if (spvVersion.vulkan > 0) {
4223         // ...then streams apply to built-in blocks, instead of them being only on stream 0
4224         type.getQualifier().layoutStream = currentBlockQualifier.layoutStream;
4225     }
4226 
4227     if (numOriginalMembersFound < newTypeList.size())
4228         error(loc, "block redeclaration has extra members", blockName.c_str(), "");
4229     if (type.isArray() != (arraySizes != nullptr) ||
4230         (type.isArray() && arraySizes != nullptr && type.getArraySizes()->getNumDims() != arraySizes->getNumDims()))
4231         error(loc, "cannot change arrayness of redeclared block", blockName.c_str(), "");
4232     else if (type.isArray()) {
4233         // At this point, we know both are arrays and both have the same number of dimensions.
4234 
4235         // It is okay for a built-in block redeclaration to be unsized, and keep the size of the
4236         // original block declaration.
4237         if (!arraySizes->isSized() && type.isSizedArray())
4238             arraySizes->changeOuterSize(type.getOuterArraySize());
4239 
4240         // And, okay to be giving a size to the array, by the redeclaration
4241         if (!type.isSizedArray() && arraySizes->isSized())
4242             type.changeOuterArraySize(arraySizes->getOuterSize());
4243 
4244         // Now, they must match in all dimensions.
4245         if (type.isSizedArray() && *type.getArraySizes() != *arraySizes)
4246             error(loc, "cannot change array size of redeclared block", blockName.c_str(), "");
4247     }
4248 
4249     symbolTable.insert(*block);
4250 
4251     // Check for general layout qualifier errors
4252     layoutObjectCheck(loc, *block);
4253 
4254     // Tracking for implicit sizing of array
4255     if (isIoResizeArray(block->getType())) {
4256         ioArraySymbolResizeList.push_back(block);
4257         checkIoArraysConsistency(loc, true, block->getType().getQualifier().isPerPrimitive());
4258     } else if (block->getType().isArray())
4259         fixIoArraySize(loc, block->getWritableType());
4260 
4261     // Save it in the AST for linker use.
4262     trackLinkage(*block);
4263 }
4264 
paramCheckFixStorage(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TStorageQualifier & qualifier,TType & type)4265 void TParseContext::paramCheckFixStorage(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TStorageQualifier& qualifier, TType& type)
4266 {
4267     switch (qualifier) {
4268     case EvqConst:
4269     case EvqConstReadOnly:
4270         type.getQualifier().storage = EvqConstReadOnly;
4271         break;
4272     case EvqIn:
4273     case EvqOut:
4274     case EvqInOut:
4275         type.getQualifier().storage = qualifier;
4276         break;
4277     case EvqGlobal:
4278     case EvqTemporary:
4279         type.getQualifier().storage = EvqIn;
4280         break;
4281     default:
4282         type.getQualifier().storage = EvqIn;
4283         error(loc, "storage qualifier not allowed on function parameter", GetStorageQualifierString(qualifier), "");
4284         break;
4285     }
4286 }
4287 
paramCheckFix(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TQualifier & qualifier,TType & type)4288 void TParseContext::paramCheckFix(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TQualifier& qualifier, TType& type)
4289 {
4290     if (qualifier.isMemory()) {
4291         type.getQualifier().volatil   = qualifier.volatil;
4292         type.getQualifier().coherent  = qualifier.coherent;
4293         type.getQualifier().devicecoherent  = qualifier.devicecoherent ;
4294         type.getQualifier().queuefamilycoherent  = qualifier.queuefamilycoherent;
4295         type.getQualifier().workgroupcoherent  = qualifier.workgroupcoherent;
4296         type.getQualifier().subgroupcoherent  = qualifier.subgroupcoherent;
4297         type.getQualifier().nonprivate = qualifier.nonprivate;
4298         type.getQualifier().readonly  = qualifier.readonly;
4299         type.getQualifier().writeonly = qualifier.writeonly;
4300         type.getQualifier().restrict  = qualifier.restrict;
4301     }
4302 
4303     if (qualifier.isAuxiliary() ||
4304         qualifier.isInterpolation())
4305         error(loc, "cannot use auxiliary or interpolation qualifiers on a function parameter", "", "");
4306     if (qualifier.hasLayout())
4307         error(loc, "cannot use layout qualifiers on a function parameter", "", "");
4308     if (qualifier.invariant)
4309         error(loc, "cannot use invariant qualifier on a function parameter", "", "");
4310     if (qualifier.noContraction) {
4311         if (qualifier.isParamOutput())
4312             type.getQualifier().noContraction = true;
4313         else
4314             warn(loc, "qualifier has no effect on non-output parameters", "precise", "");
4315     }
4316     if (qualifier.isNonUniform())
4317         type.getQualifier().nonUniform = qualifier.nonUniform;
4318 
4319     paramCheckFixStorage(loc, qualifier.storage, type);
4320 }
4321 
nestedBlockCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc)4322 void TParseContext::nestedBlockCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc)
4323 {
4324     if (structNestingLevel > 0)
4325         error(loc, "cannot nest a block definition inside a structure or block", "", "");
4326     ++structNestingLevel;
4327 }
4328 
nestedStructCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc)4329 void TParseContext::nestedStructCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc)
4330 {
4331     if (structNestingLevel > 0)
4332         error(loc, "cannot nest a structure definition inside a structure or block", "", "");
4333     ++structNestingLevel;
4334 }
4335 
arrayObjectCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TType & type,const char * op)4336 void TParseContext::arrayObjectCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TType& type, const char* op)
4337 {
4338     // Some versions don't allow comparing arrays or structures containing arrays
4339     if (type.containsArray()) {
4340         profileRequires(loc, ENoProfile, 120, E_GL_3DL_array_objects, op);
4341         profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, op);
4342     }
4343 }
4344 
opaqueCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TType & type,const char * op)4345 void TParseContext::opaqueCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TType& type, const char* op)
4346 {
4347     if (containsFieldWithBasicType(type, EbtSampler))
4348         error(loc, "can't use with samplers or structs containing samplers", op, "");
4349 }
4350 
storage16BitAssignmentCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TType & type,const char * op)4351 void TParseContext::storage16BitAssignmentCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TType& type, const char* op)
4352 {
4353     if (type.getBasicType() == EbtStruct && containsFieldWithBasicType(type, EbtFloat16))
4354         requireFloat16Arithmetic(loc, op, "can't use with structs containing float16");
4355 
4356     if (type.isArray() && type.getBasicType() == EbtFloat16)
4357         requireFloat16Arithmetic(loc, op, "can't use with arrays containing float16");
4358 
4359     if (type.getBasicType() == EbtStruct && containsFieldWithBasicType(type, EbtInt16))
4360         requireInt16Arithmetic(loc, op, "can't use with structs containing int16");
4361 
4362     if (type.isArray() && type.getBasicType() == EbtInt16)
4363         requireInt16Arithmetic(loc, op, "can't use with arrays containing int16");
4364 
4365     if (type.getBasicType() == EbtStruct && containsFieldWithBasicType(type, EbtUint16))
4366         requireInt16Arithmetic(loc, op, "can't use with structs containing uint16");
4367 
4368     if (type.isArray() && type.getBasicType() == EbtUint16)
4369         requireInt16Arithmetic(loc, op, "can't use with arrays containing uint16");
4370 
4371     if (type.getBasicType() == EbtStruct && containsFieldWithBasicType(type, EbtInt8))
4372         requireInt8Arithmetic(loc, op, "can't use with structs containing int8");
4373 
4374     if (type.isArray() && type.getBasicType() == EbtInt8)
4375         requireInt8Arithmetic(loc, op, "can't use with arrays containing int8");
4376 
4377     if (type.getBasicType() == EbtStruct && containsFieldWithBasicType(type, EbtUint8))
4378         requireInt8Arithmetic(loc, op, "can't use with structs containing uint8");
4379 
4380     if (type.isArray() && type.getBasicType() == EbtUint8)
4381         requireInt8Arithmetic(loc, op, "can't use with arrays containing uint8");
4382 }
4383 
specializationCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TType & type,const char * op)4384 void TParseContext::specializationCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TType& type, const char* op)
4385 {
4386     if (type.containsSpecializationSize())
4387         error(loc, "can't use with types containing arrays sized with a specialization constant", op, "");
4388 }
4389 
structTypeCheck(const TSourceLoc &,TPublicType & publicType)4390 void TParseContext::structTypeCheck(const TSourceLoc& /*loc*/, TPublicType& publicType)
4391 {
4392     const TTypeList& typeList = *publicType.userDef->getStruct();
4393 
4394     // fix and check for member storage qualifiers and types that don't belong within a structure
4395     for (unsigned int member = 0; member < typeList.size(); ++member) {
4396         TQualifier& memberQualifier = typeList[member].type->getQualifier();
4397         const TSourceLoc& memberLoc = typeList[member].loc;
4398         if (memberQualifier.isAuxiliary() ||
4399             memberQualifier.isInterpolation() ||
4400             (memberQualifier.storage != EvqTemporary && memberQualifier.storage != EvqGlobal))
4401             error(memberLoc, "cannot use storage or interpolation qualifiers on structure members", typeList[member].type->getFieldName().c_str(), "");
4402         if (memberQualifier.isMemory())
4403             error(memberLoc, "cannot use memory qualifiers on structure members", typeList[member].type->getFieldName().c_str(), "");
4404         if (memberQualifier.hasLayout()) {
4405             error(memberLoc, "cannot use layout qualifiers on structure members", typeList[member].type->getFieldName().c_str(), "");
4406             memberQualifier.clearLayout();
4407         }
4408         if (memberQualifier.invariant)
4409             error(memberLoc, "cannot use invariant qualifier on structure members", typeList[member].type->getFieldName().c_str(), "");
4410     }
4411 }
4412 
4413 //
4414 // See if this loop satisfies the limitations for ES 2.0 (version 100) for loops in Appendex A:
4415 //
4416 // "The loop index has type int or float.
4417 //
4418 // "The for statement has the form:
4419 //     for ( init-declaration ; condition ; expression )
4420 //     init-declaration has the form: type-specifier identifier = constant-expression
4421 //     condition has the form:  loop-index relational_operator constant-expression
4422 //         where relational_operator is one of: > >= < <= == or !=
4423 //     expression [sic] has one of the following forms:
4424 //         loop-index++
4425 //         loop-index--
4426 //         loop-index += constant-expression
4427 //         loop-index -= constant-expression
4428 //
4429 // The body is handled in an AST traversal.
4430 //
inductiveLoopCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,TIntermNode * init,TIntermLoop * loop)4431 void TParseContext::inductiveLoopCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, TIntermNode* init, TIntermLoop* loop)
4432 {
4433     // loop index init must exist and be a declaration, which shows up in the AST as an aggregate of size 1 of the declaration
4434     bool badInit = false;
4435     if (! init || ! init->getAsAggregate() || init->getAsAggregate()->getSequence().size() != 1)
4436         badInit = true;
4437     TIntermBinary* binaryInit = 0;
4438     if (! badInit) {
4439         // get the declaration assignment
4440         binaryInit = init->getAsAggregate()->getSequence()[0]->getAsBinaryNode();
4441         if (! binaryInit)
4442             badInit = true;
4443     }
4444     if (badInit) {
4445         error(loc, "inductive-loop init-declaration requires the form \"type-specifier loop-index = constant-expression\"", "limitations", "");
4446         return;
4447     }
4448 
4449     // loop index must be type int or float
4450     if (! binaryInit->getType().isScalar() || (binaryInit->getBasicType() != EbtInt && binaryInit->getBasicType() != EbtFloat)) {
4451         error(loc, "inductive loop requires a scalar 'int' or 'float' loop index", "limitations", "");
4452         return;
4453     }
4454 
4455     // init is the form "loop-index = constant"
4456     if (binaryInit->getOp() != EOpAssign || ! binaryInit->getLeft()->getAsSymbolNode() || ! binaryInit->getRight()->getAsConstantUnion()) {
4457         error(loc, "inductive-loop init-declaration requires the form \"type-specifier loop-index = constant-expression\"", "limitations", "");
4458         return;
4459     }
4460 
4461     // get the unique id of the loop index
4462     int loopIndex = binaryInit->getLeft()->getAsSymbolNode()->getId();
4463     inductiveLoopIds.insert(loopIndex);
4464 
4465     // condition's form must be "loop-index relational-operator constant-expression"
4466     bool badCond = ! loop->getTest();
4467     if (! badCond) {
4468         TIntermBinary* binaryCond = loop->getTest()->getAsBinaryNode();
4469         badCond = ! binaryCond;
4470         if (! badCond) {
4471             switch (binaryCond->getOp()) {
4472             case EOpGreaterThan:
4473             case EOpGreaterThanEqual:
4474             case EOpLessThan:
4475             case EOpLessThanEqual:
4476             case EOpEqual:
4477             case EOpNotEqual:
4478                 break;
4479             default:
4480                 badCond = true;
4481             }
4482         }
4483         if (binaryCond && (! binaryCond->getLeft()->getAsSymbolNode() ||
4484                            binaryCond->getLeft()->getAsSymbolNode()->getId() != loopIndex ||
4485                            ! binaryCond->getRight()->getAsConstantUnion()))
4486             badCond = true;
4487     }
4488     if (badCond) {
4489         error(loc, "inductive-loop condition requires the form \"loop-index <comparison-op> constant-expression\"", "limitations", "");
4490         return;
4491     }
4492 
4493     // loop-index++
4494     // loop-index--
4495     // loop-index += constant-expression
4496     // loop-index -= constant-expression
4497     bool badTerminal = ! loop->getTerminal();
4498     if (! badTerminal) {
4499         TIntermUnary* unaryTerminal = loop->getTerminal()->getAsUnaryNode();
4500         TIntermBinary* binaryTerminal = loop->getTerminal()->getAsBinaryNode();
4501         if (unaryTerminal || binaryTerminal) {
4502             switch(loop->getTerminal()->getAsOperator()->getOp()) {
4503             case EOpPostDecrement:
4504             case EOpPostIncrement:
4505             case EOpAddAssign:
4506             case EOpSubAssign:
4507                 break;
4508             default:
4509                 badTerminal = true;
4510             }
4511         } else
4512             badTerminal = true;
4513         if (binaryTerminal && (! binaryTerminal->getLeft()->getAsSymbolNode() ||
4514                                binaryTerminal->getLeft()->getAsSymbolNode()->getId() != loopIndex ||
4515                                ! binaryTerminal->getRight()->getAsConstantUnion()))
4516             badTerminal = true;
4517         if (unaryTerminal && (! unaryTerminal->getOperand()->getAsSymbolNode() ||
4518                               unaryTerminal->getOperand()->getAsSymbolNode()->getId() != loopIndex))
4519             badTerminal = true;
4520     }
4521     if (badTerminal) {
4522         error(loc, "inductive-loop termination requires the form \"loop-index++, loop-index--, loop-index += constant-expression, or loop-index -= constant-expression\"", "limitations", "");
4523         return;
4524     }
4525 
4526     // the body
4527     inductiveLoopBodyCheck(loop->getBody(), loopIndex, symbolTable);
4528 }
4529 
4530 // Do limit checks for built-in arrays.
arrayLimitCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TString & identifier,int size)4531 void TParseContext::arrayLimitCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TString& identifier, int size)
4532 {
4533     if (identifier.compare("gl_TexCoord") == 0)
4534         limitCheck(loc, size, "gl_MaxTextureCoords", "gl_TexCoord array size");
4535     else if (identifier.compare("gl_ClipDistance") == 0)
4536         limitCheck(loc, size, "gl_MaxClipDistances", "gl_ClipDistance array size");
4537     else if (identifier.compare("gl_CullDistance") == 0)
4538         limitCheck(loc, size, "gl_MaxCullDistances", "gl_CullDistance array size");
4539 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
4540     else if (identifier.compare("gl_ClipDistancePerViewNV") == 0)
4541         limitCheck(loc, size, "gl_MaxClipDistances", "gl_ClipDistancePerViewNV array size");
4542     else if (identifier.compare("gl_CullDistancePerViewNV") == 0)
4543         limitCheck(loc, size, "gl_MaxCullDistances", "gl_CullDistancePerViewNV array size");
4544 #endif
4545 }
4546 
4547 // See if the provided value is less than or equal to the symbol indicated by limit,
4548 // which should be a constant in the symbol table.
limitCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,int value,const char * limit,const char * feature)4549 void TParseContext::limitCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, int value, const char* limit, const char* feature)
4550 {
4551     TSymbol* symbol = symbolTable.find(limit);
4552     assert(symbol->getAsVariable());
4553     const TConstUnionArray& constArray = symbol->getAsVariable()->getConstArray();
4554     assert(! constArray.empty());
4555     if (value > constArray[0].getIConst())
4556         error(loc, "must be less than or equal to", feature, "%s (%d)", limit, constArray[0].getIConst());
4557 }
4558 
4559 //
4560 // Do any additional error checking, etc., once we know the parsing is done.
4561 //
finish()4562 void TParseContext::finish()
4563 {
4564     TParseContextBase::finish();
4565 
4566     if (parsingBuiltins)
4567         return;
4568 
4569     // Check on array indexes for ES 2.0 (version 100) limitations.
4570     for (size_t i = 0; i < needsIndexLimitationChecking.size(); ++i)
4571         constantIndexExpressionCheck(needsIndexLimitationChecking[i]);
4572 
4573     // Check for stages that are enabled by extension.
4574     // Can't do this at the beginning, it is chicken and egg to add a stage by
4575     // extension.
4576     // Stage-specific features were correctly tested for already, this is just
4577     // about the stage itself.
4578     switch (language) {
4579     case EShLangGeometry:
4580         if (profile == EEsProfile && version == 310)
4581             requireExtensions(getCurrentLoc(), Num_AEP_geometry_shader, AEP_geometry_shader, "geometry shaders");
4582         break;
4583     case EShLangTessControl:
4584     case EShLangTessEvaluation:
4585         if (profile == EEsProfile && version == 310)
4586             requireExtensions(getCurrentLoc(), Num_AEP_tessellation_shader, AEP_tessellation_shader, "tessellation shaders");
4587         else if (profile != EEsProfile && version < 400)
4588             requireExtensions(getCurrentLoc(), 1, &E_GL_ARB_tessellation_shader, "tessellation shaders");
4589         break;
4590     case EShLangCompute:
4591         if (profile != EEsProfile && version < 430)
4592             requireExtensions(getCurrentLoc(), 1, &E_GL_ARB_compute_shader, "compute shaders");
4593         break;
4594 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
4595     case EShLangTaskNV:
4596         requireExtensions(getCurrentLoc(), 1, &E_GL_NV_mesh_shader, "task shaders");
4597         break;
4598     case EShLangMeshNV:
4599         requireExtensions(getCurrentLoc(), 1, &E_GL_NV_mesh_shader, "mesh shaders");
4600         break;
4601 #endif
4602     default:
4603         break;
4604     }
4605 
4606 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
4607     // Set default outputs for GL_NV_geometry_shader_passthrough
4608     if (language == EShLangGeometry && extensionTurnedOn(E_SPV_NV_geometry_shader_passthrough)) {
4609         if (intermediate.getOutputPrimitive() == ElgNone) {
4610             switch (intermediate.getInputPrimitive()) {
4611             case ElgPoints:      intermediate.setOutputPrimitive(ElgPoints);    break;
4612             case ElgLines:       intermediate.setOutputPrimitive(ElgLineStrip); break;
4613             case ElgTriangles:   intermediate.setOutputPrimitive(ElgTriangleStrip); break;
4614             default: break;
4615             }
4616         }
4617         if (intermediate.getVertices() == TQualifier::layoutNotSet) {
4618             switch (intermediate.getInputPrimitive()) {
4619             case ElgPoints:      intermediate.setVertices(1); break;
4620             case ElgLines:       intermediate.setVertices(2); break;
4621             case ElgTriangles:   intermediate.setVertices(3); break;
4622             default: break;
4623             }
4624         }
4625     }
4626 #endif
4627 }
4628 
4629 //
4630 // Layout qualifier stuff.
4631 //
4632 
4633 // Put the id's layout qualification into the public type, for qualifiers not having a number set.
4634 // This is before we know any type information for error checking.
setLayoutQualifier(const TSourceLoc & loc,TPublicType & publicType,TString & id)4635 void TParseContext::setLayoutQualifier(const TSourceLoc& loc, TPublicType& publicType, TString& id)
4636 {
4637     std::transform(id.begin(), id.end(), id.begin(), ::tolower);
4638 
4639     if (id == TQualifier::getLayoutMatrixString(ElmColumnMajor)) {
4640         publicType.qualifier.layoutMatrix = ElmColumnMajor;
4641         return;
4642     }
4643     if (id == TQualifier::getLayoutMatrixString(ElmRowMajor)) {
4644         publicType.qualifier.layoutMatrix = ElmRowMajor;
4645         return;
4646     }
4647     if (id == TQualifier::getLayoutPackingString(ElpPacked)) {
4648         if (spvVersion.spv != 0)
4649             spvRemoved(loc, "packed");
4650         publicType.qualifier.layoutPacking = ElpPacked;
4651         return;
4652     }
4653     if (id == TQualifier::getLayoutPackingString(ElpShared)) {
4654         if (spvVersion.spv != 0)
4655             spvRemoved(loc, "shared");
4656         publicType.qualifier.layoutPacking = ElpShared;
4657         return;
4658     }
4659     if (id == TQualifier::getLayoutPackingString(ElpStd140)) {
4660         publicType.qualifier.layoutPacking = ElpStd140;
4661         return;
4662     }
4663     if (id == TQualifier::getLayoutPackingString(ElpStd430)) {
4664         requireProfile(loc, EEsProfile | ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, "std430");
4665         profileRequires(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, 430, nullptr, "std430");
4666         profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 310, nullptr, "std430");
4667         publicType.qualifier.layoutPacking = ElpStd430;
4668         return;
4669     }
4670     if (id == TQualifier::getLayoutPackingString(ElpScalar)) {
4671         requireVulkan(loc, "scalar");
4672         requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_EXT_scalar_block_layout, "scalar block layout");
4673         publicType.qualifier.layoutPacking = ElpScalar;
4674         return;
4675     }
4676     // TODO: compile-time performance: may need to stop doing linear searches
4677     for (TLayoutFormat format = (TLayoutFormat)(ElfNone + 1); format < ElfCount; format = (TLayoutFormat)(format + 1)) {
4678         if (id == TQualifier::getLayoutFormatString(format)) {
4679             if ((format > ElfEsFloatGuard && format < ElfFloatGuard) ||
4680                 (format > ElfEsIntGuard && format < ElfIntGuard) ||
4681                 (format > ElfEsUintGuard && format < ElfCount))
4682                 requireProfile(loc, ENoProfile | ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, "image load-store format");
4683             profileRequires(loc, ENoProfile | ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, 420, E_GL_ARB_shader_image_load_store, "image load store");
4684             profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 310, E_GL_ARB_shader_image_load_store, "image load store");
4685             publicType.qualifier.layoutFormat = format;
4686             return;
4687         }
4688     }
4689     if (id == "push_constant") {
4690         requireVulkan(loc, "push_constant");
4691         publicType.qualifier.layoutPushConstant = true;
4692         return;
4693     }
4694     if (id == "buffer_reference") {
4695         requireVulkan(loc, "buffer_reference");
4696         requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_EXT_buffer_reference, "buffer_reference");
4697         publicType.qualifier.layoutBufferReference = true;
4698         intermediate.setUseStorageBuffer();
4699         intermediate.setUsePhysicalStorageBuffer();
4700         return;
4701     }
4702     if (language == EShLangGeometry || language == EShLangTessEvaluation
4703 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
4704         || language == EShLangMeshNV
4705 #endif
4706        ) {
4707         if (id == TQualifier::getGeometryString(ElgTriangles)) {
4708             publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry = ElgTriangles;
4709             return;
4710         }
4711         if (language == EShLangGeometry
4712 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
4713             || language == EShLangMeshNV
4714 #endif
4715            ) {
4716             if (id == TQualifier::getGeometryString(ElgPoints)) {
4717                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry = ElgPoints;
4718                 return;
4719             }
4720             if (id == TQualifier::getGeometryString(ElgLines)) {
4721                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry = ElgLines;
4722                 return;
4723             }
4724 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
4725             if (language == EShLangGeometry)
4726 #endif
4727             {
4728                 if (id == TQualifier::getGeometryString(ElgLineStrip)) {
4729                     publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry = ElgLineStrip;
4730                     return;
4731                 }
4732                 if (id == TQualifier::getGeometryString(ElgLinesAdjacency)) {
4733                     publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry = ElgLinesAdjacency;
4734                     return;
4735                 }
4736                 if (id == TQualifier::getGeometryString(ElgTrianglesAdjacency)) {
4737                     publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry = ElgTrianglesAdjacency;
4738                     return;
4739                 }
4740                 if (id == TQualifier::getGeometryString(ElgTriangleStrip)) {
4741                     publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry = ElgTriangleStrip;
4742                     return;
4743                 }
4744 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
4745                 if (id == "passthrough") {
4746                     requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_SPV_NV_geometry_shader_passthrough, "geometry shader passthrough");
4747                     publicType.qualifier.layoutPassthrough = true;
4748                     intermediate.setGeoPassthroughEXT();
4749                     return;
4750                 }
4751 #endif
4752             }
4753         } else {
4754             assert(language == EShLangTessEvaluation);
4755 
4756             // input primitive
4757             if (id == TQualifier::getGeometryString(ElgTriangles)) {
4758                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry = ElgTriangles;
4759                 return;
4760             }
4761             if (id == TQualifier::getGeometryString(ElgQuads)) {
4762                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry = ElgQuads;
4763                 return;
4764             }
4765             if (id == TQualifier::getGeometryString(ElgIsolines)) {
4766                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry = ElgIsolines;
4767                 return;
4768             }
4769 
4770             // vertex spacing
4771             if (id == TQualifier::getVertexSpacingString(EvsEqual)) {
4772                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.spacing = EvsEqual;
4773                 return;
4774             }
4775             if (id == TQualifier::getVertexSpacingString(EvsFractionalEven)) {
4776                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.spacing = EvsFractionalEven;
4777                 return;
4778             }
4779             if (id == TQualifier::getVertexSpacingString(EvsFractionalOdd)) {
4780                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.spacing = EvsFractionalOdd;
4781                 return;
4782             }
4783 
4784             // triangle order
4785             if (id == TQualifier::getVertexOrderString(EvoCw)) {
4786                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.order = EvoCw;
4787                 return;
4788             }
4789             if (id == TQualifier::getVertexOrderString(EvoCcw)) {
4790                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.order = EvoCcw;
4791                 return;
4792             }
4793 
4794             // point mode
4795             if (id == "point_mode") {
4796                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.pointMode = true;
4797                 return;
4798             }
4799         }
4800     }
4801     if (language == EShLangFragment) {
4802         if (id == "origin_upper_left") {
4803             requireProfile(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, "origin_upper_left");
4804             publicType.shaderQualifiers.originUpperLeft = true;
4805             return;
4806         }
4807         if (id == "pixel_center_integer") {
4808             requireProfile(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, "pixel_center_integer");
4809             publicType.shaderQualifiers.pixelCenterInteger = true;
4810             return;
4811         }
4812         if (id == "early_fragment_tests") {
4813             profileRequires(loc, ENoProfile | ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, 420, E_GL_ARB_shader_image_load_store, "early_fragment_tests");
4814             profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 310, nullptr, "early_fragment_tests");
4815             publicType.shaderQualifiers.earlyFragmentTests = true;
4816             return;
4817         }
4818         if (id == "post_depth_coverage") {
4819             requireExtensions(loc, Num_post_depth_coverageEXTs, post_depth_coverageEXTs, "post depth coverage");
4820             if (extensionTurnedOn(E_GL_ARB_post_depth_coverage)) {
4821                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.earlyFragmentTests = true;
4822             }
4823             publicType.shaderQualifiers.postDepthCoverage = true;
4824             return;
4825         }
4826         for (TLayoutDepth depth = (TLayoutDepth)(EldNone + 1); depth < EldCount; depth = (TLayoutDepth)(depth+1)) {
4827             if (id == TQualifier::getLayoutDepthString(depth)) {
4828                 requireProfile(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, "depth layout qualifier");
4829                 profileRequires(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, 420, nullptr, "depth layout qualifier");
4830                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.layoutDepth = depth;
4831                 return;
4832             }
4833         }
4834         if (id.compare(0, 13, "blend_support") == 0) {
4835             bool found = false;
4836             for (TBlendEquationShift be = (TBlendEquationShift)0; be < EBlendCount; be = (TBlendEquationShift)(be + 1)) {
4837                 if (id == TQualifier::getBlendEquationString(be)) {
4838                     profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 320, E_GL_KHR_blend_equation_advanced, "blend equation");
4839                     profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 0, E_GL_KHR_blend_equation_advanced, "blend equation");
4840                     intermediate.addBlendEquation(be);
4841                     publicType.shaderQualifiers.blendEquation = true;
4842                     found = true;
4843                     break;
4844                 }
4845             }
4846             if (! found)
4847                 error(loc, "unknown blend equation", "blend_support", "");
4848             return;
4849         }
4850 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
4851         if (id == "override_coverage") {
4852             requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_NV_sample_mask_override_coverage, "sample mask override coverage");
4853             publicType.shaderQualifiers.layoutOverrideCoverage = true;
4854             return;
4855         }
4856     }
4857     if (language == EShLangVertex ||
4858         language == EShLangTessControl ||
4859         language == EShLangTessEvaluation ||
4860         language == EShLangGeometry ) {
4861         if (id == "viewport_relative") {
4862             requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_NV_viewport_array2, "view port array2");
4863             publicType.qualifier.layoutViewportRelative = true;
4864             return;
4865         }
4866     } else {
4867         if (language == EShLangRayGenNV || language == EShLangIntersectNV ||
4868         language == EShLangAnyHitNV || language == EShLangClosestHitNV ||
4869         language == EShLangMissNV || language == EShLangCallableNV) {
4870             if (id == "shaderrecordnv") {
4871                 publicType.qualifier.layoutShaderRecordNV = true;
4872                 return;
4873             }
4874         }
4875     }
4876     if (language == EShLangCompute) {
4877         if (id.compare(0, 17, "derivative_group_") == 0) {
4878             requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_NV_compute_shader_derivatives, "compute shader derivatives");
4879             if (id == "derivative_group_quadsnv") {
4880                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.layoutDerivativeGroupQuads = true;
4881                 return;
4882             } else if (id == "derivative_group_linearnv") {
4883                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.layoutDerivativeGroupLinear = true;
4884                 return;
4885             }
4886         }
4887     }
4888 #else
4889     }
4890 #endif
4891     error(loc, "unrecognized layout identifier, or qualifier requires assignment (e.g., binding = 4)", id.c_str(), "");
4892 }
4893 
4894 // Put the id's layout qualifier value into the public type, for qualifiers having a number set.
4895 // This is before we know any type information for error checking.
setLayoutQualifier(const TSourceLoc & loc,TPublicType & publicType,TString & id,const TIntermTyped * node)4896 void TParseContext::setLayoutQualifier(const TSourceLoc& loc, TPublicType& publicType, TString& id, const TIntermTyped* node)
4897 {
4898     const char* feature = "layout-id value";
4899     const char* nonLiteralFeature = "non-literal layout-id value";
4900 
4901     integerCheck(node, feature);
4902     const TIntermConstantUnion* constUnion = node->getAsConstantUnion();
4903     int value;
4904     if (constUnion) {
4905         value = constUnion->getConstArray()[0].getIConst();
4906         if (! constUnion->isLiteral()) {
4907             requireProfile(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, nonLiteralFeature);
4908             profileRequires(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, 440, E_GL_ARB_enhanced_layouts, nonLiteralFeature);
4909         }
4910     } else {
4911         // grammar should have give out the error message
4912         value = 0;
4913     }
4914 
4915     if (value < 0) {
4916         error(loc, "cannot be negative", feature, "");
4917         return;
4918     }
4919 
4920     std::transform(id.begin(), id.end(), id.begin(), ::tolower);
4921 
4922     if (id == "offset") {
4923         // "offset" can be for either
4924         //  - uniform offsets
4925         //  - atomic_uint offsets
4926         const char* feature = "offset";
4927         if (spvVersion.spv == 0) {
4928             requireProfile(loc, EEsProfile | ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, feature);
4929             const char* exts[2] = { E_GL_ARB_enhanced_layouts, E_GL_ARB_shader_atomic_counters };
4930             profileRequires(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, 420, 2, exts, feature);
4931             profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 310, nullptr, feature);
4932         }
4933         publicType.qualifier.layoutOffset = value;
4934         return;
4935     } else if (id == "align") {
4936         const char* feature = "uniform buffer-member align";
4937         if (spvVersion.spv == 0) {
4938             requireProfile(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, feature);
4939             profileRequires(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, 440, E_GL_ARB_enhanced_layouts, feature);
4940         }
4941         // "The specified alignment must be a power of 2, or a compile-time error results."
4942         if (! IsPow2(value))
4943             error(loc, "must be a power of 2", "align", "");
4944         else
4945             publicType.qualifier.layoutAlign = value;
4946         return;
4947     } else if (id == "location") {
4948         profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, "location");
4949         const char* exts[2] = { E_GL_ARB_separate_shader_objects, E_GL_ARB_explicit_attrib_location };
4950         profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 330, 2, exts, "location");
4951         if ((unsigned int)value >= TQualifier::layoutLocationEnd)
4952             error(loc, "location is too large", id.c_str(), "");
4953         else
4954             publicType.qualifier.layoutLocation = value;
4955         return;
4956     } else if (id == "set") {
4957         if ((unsigned int)value >= TQualifier::layoutSetEnd)
4958             error(loc, "set is too large", id.c_str(), "");
4959         else
4960             publicType.qualifier.layoutSet = value;
4961         if (value != 0)
4962             requireVulkan(loc, "descriptor set");
4963         return;
4964     } else if (id == "binding") {
4965         profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 420, E_GL_ARB_shading_language_420pack, "binding");
4966         profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 310, nullptr, "binding");
4967         if ((unsigned int)value >= TQualifier::layoutBindingEnd)
4968             error(loc, "binding is too large", id.c_str(), "");
4969         else
4970             publicType.qualifier.layoutBinding = value;
4971         return;
4972     } else if (id == "component") {
4973         requireProfile(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, "component");
4974         profileRequires(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, 440, E_GL_ARB_enhanced_layouts, "component");
4975         if ((unsigned)value >= TQualifier::layoutComponentEnd)
4976             error(loc, "component is too large", id.c_str(), "");
4977         else
4978             publicType.qualifier.layoutComponent = value;
4979         return;
4980     } else if (id.compare(0, 4, "xfb_") == 0) {
4981         // "Any shader making any static use (after preprocessing) of any of these
4982         // *xfb_* qualifiers will cause the shader to be in a transform feedback
4983         // capturing mode and hence responsible for describing the transform feedback
4984         // setup."
4985         intermediate.setXfbMode();
4986         const char* feature = "transform feedback qualifier";
4987         requireStage(loc, (EShLanguageMask)(EShLangVertexMask | EShLangGeometryMask | EShLangTessControlMask | EShLangTessEvaluationMask), feature);
4988         requireProfile(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, feature);
4989         profileRequires(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, 440, E_GL_ARB_enhanced_layouts, feature);
4990         if (id == "xfb_buffer") {
4991             // "It is a compile-time error to specify an *xfb_buffer* that is greater than
4992             // the implementation-dependent constant gl_MaxTransformFeedbackBuffers."
4993             if (value >= resources.maxTransformFeedbackBuffers)
4994                 error(loc, "buffer is too large:", id.c_str(), "gl_MaxTransformFeedbackBuffers is %d", resources.maxTransformFeedbackBuffers);
4995             if (value >= (int)TQualifier::layoutXfbBufferEnd)
4996                 error(loc, "buffer is too large:", id.c_str(), "internal max is %d", TQualifier::layoutXfbBufferEnd-1);
4997             else
4998                 publicType.qualifier.layoutXfbBuffer = value;
4999             return;
5000         } else if (id == "xfb_offset") {
5001             if (value >= (int)TQualifier::layoutXfbOffsetEnd)
5002                 error(loc, "offset is too large:", id.c_str(), "internal max is %d", TQualifier::layoutXfbOffsetEnd-1);
5003             else
5004                 publicType.qualifier.layoutXfbOffset = value;
5005             return;
5006         } else if (id == "xfb_stride") {
5007             // "The resulting stride (implicit or explicit), when divided by 4, must be less than or equal to the
5008             // implementation-dependent constant gl_MaxTransformFeedbackInterleavedComponents."
5009             if (value > 4 * resources.maxTransformFeedbackInterleavedComponents) {
5010                 error(loc, "1/4 stride is too large:", id.c_str(), "gl_MaxTransformFeedbackInterleavedComponents is %d",
5011                     resources.maxTransformFeedbackInterleavedComponents);
5012             }
5013             if (value >= (int)TQualifier::layoutXfbStrideEnd)
5014                 error(loc, "stride is too large:", id.c_str(), "internal max is %d", TQualifier::layoutXfbStrideEnd-1);
5015             else
5016                 publicType.qualifier.layoutXfbStride = value;
5017             return;
5018         }
5019     }
5020 
5021     if (id == "input_attachment_index") {
5022         requireVulkan(loc, "input_attachment_index");
5023         if (value >= (int)TQualifier::layoutAttachmentEnd)
5024             error(loc, "attachment index is too large", id.c_str(), "");
5025         else
5026             publicType.qualifier.layoutAttachment = value;
5027         return;
5028     }
5029     if (id == "constant_id") {
5030         requireSpv(loc, "constant_id");
5031         if (value >= (int)TQualifier::layoutSpecConstantIdEnd) {
5032             error(loc, "specialization-constant id is too large", id.c_str(), "");
5033         } else {
5034             publicType.qualifier.layoutSpecConstantId = value;
5035             publicType.qualifier.specConstant = true;
5036             if (! intermediate.addUsedConstantId(value))
5037                 error(loc, "specialization-constant id already used", id.c_str(), "");
5038         }
5039         return;
5040     }
5041     if (id == "num_views") {
5042         requireExtensions(loc, Num_OVR_multiview_EXTs, OVR_multiview_EXTs, "num_views");
5043         publicType.shaderQualifiers.numViews = value;
5044         return;
5045     }
5046 
5047 #if NV_EXTENSIONS
5048     if (language == EShLangVertex ||
5049         language == EShLangTessControl ||
5050         language == EShLangTessEvaluation ||
5051         language == EShLangGeometry) {
5052         if (id == "secondary_view_offset") {
5053             requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_NV_stereo_view_rendering, "stereo view rendering");
5054             publicType.qualifier.layoutSecondaryViewportRelativeOffset = value;
5055             return;
5056         }
5057     }
5058 #endif
5059 
5060     if (id == "buffer_reference_align") {
5061         requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_EXT_buffer_reference, "buffer_reference_align");
5062         if (! IsPow2(value))
5063             error(loc, "must be a power of 2", "buffer_reference_align", "");
5064         else
5065             publicType.qualifier.layoutBufferReferenceAlign = std::log2(value);
5066         return;
5067     }
5068 
5069     switch (language) {
5070     case EShLangVertex:
5071         break;
5072 
5073     case EShLangTessControl:
5074         if (id == "vertices") {
5075             if (value == 0)
5076                 error(loc, "must be greater than 0", "vertices", "");
5077             else
5078                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.vertices = value;
5079             return;
5080         }
5081         break;
5082 
5083     case EShLangTessEvaluation:
5084         break;
5085 
5086     case EShLangGeometry:
5087         if (id == "invocations") {
5088             profileRequires(loc, ECompatibilityProfile | ECoreProfile, 400, nullptr, "invocations");
5089             if (value == 0)
5090                 error(loc, "must be at least 1", "invocations", "");
5091             else
5092                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.invocations = value;
5093             return;
5094         }
5095         if (id == "max_vertices") {
5096             publicType.shaderQualifiers.vertices = value;
5097             if (value > resources.maxGeometryOutputVertices)
5098                 error(loc, "too large, must be less than gl_MaxGeometryOutputVertices", "max_vertices", "");
5099             return;
5100         }
5101         if (id == "stream") {
5102             requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, "selecting output stream");
5103             publicType.qualifier.layoutStream = value;
5104             if (value > 0)
5105                 intermediate.setMultiStream();
5106             return;
5107         }
5108         break;
5109 
5110     case EShLangFragment:
5111         if (id == "index") {
5112             requireProfile(loc, ECompatibilityProfile | ECoreProfile, "index layout qualifier on fragment output");
5113             const char* exts[2] = { E_GL_ARB_separate_shader_objects, E_GL_ARB_explicit_attrib_location };
5114             profileRequires(loc, ECompatibilityProfile | ECoreProfile, 330, 2, exts, "index layout qualifier on fragment output");
5115 
5116             // "It is also a compile-time error if a fragment shader sets a layout index to less than 0 or greater than 1."
5117             if (value < 0 || value > 1) {
5118                 value = 0;
5119                 error(loc, "value must be 0 or 1", "index", "");
5120             }
5121 
5122             publicType.qualifier.layoutIndex = value;
5123             return;
5124         }
5125         break;
5126 
5127 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
5128     case EShLangMeshNV:
5129         if (id == "max_vertices") {
5130             requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_NV_mesh_shader, "max_vertices");
5131             publicType.shaderQualifiers.vertices = value;
5132             if (value > resources.maxMeshOutputVerticesNV)
5133                 error(loc, "too large, must be less than gl_MaxMeshOutputVerticesNV", "max_vertices", "");
5134             return;
5135         }
5136         if (id == "max_primitives") {
5137             requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_NV_mesh_shader, "max_primitives");
5138             publicType.shaderQualifiers.primitives = value;
5139             if (value > resources.maxMeshOutputPrimitivesNV)
5140                 error(loc, "too large, must be less than gl_MaxMeshOutputPrimitivesNV", "max_primitives", "");
5141             return;
5142         }
5143         // Fall through
5144 
5145     case EShLangTaskNV:
5146         // Fall through
5147 #endif
5148     case EShLangCompute:
5149         if (id.compare(0, 11, "local_size_") == 0) {
5150 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
5151             if (language == EShLangMeshNV || language == EShLangTaskNV) {
5152                 requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_NV_mesh_shader, "gl_WorkGroupSize");
5153             }
5154             else
5155 #endif
5156             {
5157                 profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 310, 0, "gl_WorkGroupSize");
5158                 profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 430, E_GL_ARB_compute_shader, "gl_WorkGroupSize");
5159             }
5160             if (id.size() == 12 && value == 0) {
5161                 error(loc, "must be at least 1", id.c_str(), "");
5162                 return;
5163             }
5164             if (id == "local_size_x") {
5165                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.localSize[0] = value;
5166                 return;
5167             }
5168             if (id == "local_size_y") {
5169                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.localSize[1] = value;
5170                 return;
5171             }
5172             if (id == "local_size_z") {
5173                 publicType.shaderQualifiers.localSize[2] = value;
5174                 return;
5175             }
5176             if (spvVersion.spv != 0) {
5177                 if (id == "local_size_x_id") {
5178                     publicType.shaderQualifiers.localSizeSpecId[0] = value;
5179                     return;
5180                 }
5181                 if (id == "local_size_y_id") {
5182                     publicType.shaderQualifiers.localSizeSpecId[1] = value;
5183                     return;
5184                 }
5185                 if (id == "local_size_z_id") {
5186                     publicType.shaderQualifiers.localSizeSpecId[2] = value;
5187                     return;
5188                 }
5189             }
5190         }
5191         break;
5192 
5193     default:
5194         break;
5195     }
5196 
5197     error(loc, "there is no such layout identifier for this stage taking an assigned value", id.c_str(), "");
5198 }
5199 
5200 // Merge any layout qualifier information from src into dst, leaving everything else in dst alone
5201 //
5202 // "More than one layout qualifier may appear in a single declaration.
5203 // Additionally, the same layout-qualifier-name can occur multiple times
5204 // within a layout qualifier or across multiple layout qualifiers in the
5205 // same declaration. When the same layout-qualifier-name occurs
5206 // multiple times, in a single declaration, the last occurrence overrides
5207 // the former occurrence(s).  Further, if such a layout-qualifier-name
5208 // will effect subsequent declarations or other observable behavior, it
5209 // is only the last occurrence that will have any effect, behaving as if
5210 // the earlier occurrence(s) within the declaration are not present.
5211 // This is also true for overriding layout-qualifier-names, where one
5212 // overrides the other (e.g., row_major vs. column_major); only the last
5213 // occurrence has any effect."
mergeObjectLayoutQualifiers(TQualifier & dst,const TQualifier & src,bool inheritOnly)5214 void TParseContext::mergeObjectLayoutQualifiers(TQualifier& dst, const TQualifier& src, bool inheritOnly)
5215 {
5216     if (src.hasMatrix())
5217         dst.layoutMatrix = src.layoutMatrix;
5218     if (src.hasPacking())
5219         dst.layoutPacking = src.layoutPacking;
5220 
5221     if (src.hasStream())
5222         dst.layoutStream = src.layoutStream;
5223 
5224     if (src.hasFormat())
5225         dst.layoutFormat = src.layoutFormat;
5226 
5227     if (src.hasXfbBuffer())
5228         dst.layoutXfbBuffer = src.layoutXfbBuffer;
5229 
5230     if (src.hasAlign())
5231         dst.layoutAlign = src.layoutAlign;
5232 
5233     if (src.hasBufferReferenceAlign())
5234         dst.layoutBufferReferenceAlign = src.layoutBufferReferenceAlign;
5235 
5236     if (! inheritOnly) {
5237         if (src.hasLocation())
5238             dst.layoutLocation = src.layoutLocation;
5239         if (src.hasComponent())
5240             dst.layoutComponent = src.layoutComponent;
5241         if (src.hasIndex())
5242             dst.layoutIndex = src.layoutIndex;
5243 
5244         if (src.hasOffset())
5245             dst.layoutOffset = src.layoutOffset;
5246 
5247         if (src.hasSet())
5248             dst.layoutSet = src.layoutSet;
5249         if (src.layoutBinding != TQualifier::layoutBindingEnd)
5250             dst.layoutBinding = src.layoutBinding;
5251 
5252         if (src.hasXfbStride())
5253             dst.layoutXfbStride = src.layoutXfbStride;
5254         if (src.hasXfbOffset())
5255             dst.layoutXfbOffset = src.layoutXfbOffset;
5256         if (src.hasAttachment())
5257             dst.layoutAttachment = src.layoutAttachment;
5258         if (src.hasSpecConstantId())
5259             dst.layoutSpecConstantId = src.layoutSpecConstantId;
5260 
5261         if (src.layoutPushConstant)
5262             dst.layoutPushConstant = true;
5263 
5264         if (src.layoutBufferReference)
5265             dst.layoutBufferReference = true;
5266 
5267 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
5268         if (src.layoutPassthrough)
5269             dst.layoutPassthrough = true;
5270         if (src.layoutViewportRelative)
5271             dst.layoutViewportRelative = true;
5272         if (src.layoutSecondaryViewportRelativeOffset != -2048)
5273             dst.layoutSecondaryViewportRelativeOffset = src.layoutSecondaryViewportRelativeOffset;
5274         if (src.layoutShaderRecordNV)
5275             dst.layoutShaderRecordNV = true;
5276         if (src.pervertexNV)
5277             dst.pervertexNV = true;
5278 #endif
5279     }
5280 }
5281 
5282 // Do error layout error checking given a full variable/block declaration.
layoutObjectCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TSymbol & symbol)5283 void TParseContext::layoutObjectCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TSymbol& symbol)
5284 {
5285     const TType& type = symbol.getType();
5286     const TQualifier& qualifier = type.getQualifier();
5287 
5288     // first, cross check WRT to just the type
5289     layoutTypeCheck(loc, type);
5290 
5291     // now, any remaining error checking based on the object itself
5292 
5293     if (qualifier.hasAnyLocation()) {
5294         switch (qualifier.storage) {
5295         case EvqUniform:
5296         case EvqBuffer:
5297             if (symbol.getAsVariable() == nullptr)
5298                 error(loc, "can only be used on variable declaration", "location", "");
5299             break;
5300         default:
5301             break;
5302         }
5303     }
5304 
5305     // user-variable location check, which are required for SPIR-V in/out:
5306     //  - variables have it directly,
5307     //  - blocks have it on each member (already enforced), so check first one
5308     if (spvVersion.spv > 0 && !parsingBuiltins && qualifier.builtIn == EbvNone &&
5309         !qualifier.hasLocation() && !intermediate.getAutoMapLocations()) {
5310 
5311         switch (qualifier.storage) {
5312         case EvqVaryingIn:
5313         case EvqVaryingOut:
5314             if (!type.getQualifier().isTaskMemory() &&
5315                 (type.getBasicType() != EbtBlock ||
5316                  (!(*type.getStruct())[0].type->getQualifier().hasLocation() &&
5317                    (*type.getStruct())[0].type->getQualifier().builtIn == EbvNone)))
5318                 error(loc, "SPIR-V requires location for user input/output", "location", "");
5319             break;
5320         default:
5321             break;
5322         }
5323     }
5324 
5325     // Check packing and matrix
5326     if (qualifier.hasUniformLayout()) {
5327         switch (qualifier.storage) {
5328         case EvqUniform:
5329         case EvqBuffer:
5330             if (type.getBasicType() != EbtBlock) {
5331                 if (qualifier.hasMatrix())
5332                     error(loc, "cannot specify matrix layout on a variable declaration", "layout", "");
5333                 if (qualifier.hasPacking())
5334                     error(loc, "cannot specify packing on a variable declaration", "layout", "");
5335                 // "The offset qualifier can only be used on block members of blocks..."
5336                 if (qualifier.hasOffset() && type.getBasicType() != EbtAtomicUint)
5337                     error(loc, "cannot specify on a variable declaration", "offset", "");
5338                 // "The align qualifier can only be used on blocks or block members..."
5339                 if (qualifier.hasAlign())
5340                     error(loc, "cannot specify on a variable declaration", "align", "");
5341                 if (qualifier.layoutPushConstant)
5342                     error(loc, "can only specify on a uniform block", "push_constant", "");
5343 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
5344                 if (qualifier.layoutShaderRecordNV)
5345                     error(loc, "can only specify on a buffer block", "shaderRecordNV", "");
5346 #endif
5347             }
5348             break;
5349         default:
5350             // these were already filtered by layoutTypeCheck() (or its callees)
5351             break;
5352         }
5353     }
5354 }
5355 
5356 // "For some blocks declared as arrays, the location can only be applied at the block level:
5357 // When a block is declared as an array where additional locations are needed for each member
5358 // for each block array element, it is a compile-time error to specify locations on the block
5359 // members.  That is, when locations would be under specified by applying them on block members,
5360 // they are not allowed on block members.  For arrayed interfaces (those generally having an
5361 // extra level of arrayness due to interface expansion), the outer array is stripped before
5362 // applying this rule."
layoutMemberLocationArrayCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,bool memberWithLocation,TArraySizes * arraySizes)5363 void TParseContext::layoutMemberLocationArrayCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, bool memberWithLocation,
5364     TArraySizes* arraySizes)
5365 {
5366     if (memberWithLocation && arraySizes != nullptr) {
5367         if (arraySizes->getNumDims() > (currentBlockQualifier.isArrayedIo(language) ? 1 : 0))
5368             error(loc, "cannot use in a block array where new locations are needed for each block element",
5369                        "location", "");
5370     }
5371 }
5372 
5373 // Do layout error checking with respect to a type.
layoutTypeCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TType & type)5374 void TParseContext::layoutTypeCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TType& type)
5375 {
5376     const TQualifier& qualifier = type.getQualifier();
5377 
5378     // first, intra-layout qualifier-only error checking
5379     layoutQualifierCheck(loc, qualifier);
5380 
5381     // now, error checking combining type and qualifier
5382 
5383     if (qualifier.hasAnyLocation()) {
5384         if (qualifier.hasLocation()) {
5385             if (qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingOut && language == EShLangFragment) {
5386                 if (qualifier.layoutLocation >= (unsigned int)resources.maxDrawBuffers)
5387                     error(loc, "too large for fragment output", "location", "");
5388             }
5389         }
5390         if (qualifier.hasComponent()) {
5391             // "It is a compile-time error if this sequence of components gets larger than 3."
5392             if (qualifier.layoutComponent + type.getVectorSize() * (type.getBasicType() == EbtDouble ? 2 : 1) > 4)
5393                 error(loc, "type overflows the available 4 components", "component", "");
5394 
5395             // "It is a compile-time error to apply the component qualifier to a matrix, a structure, a block, or an array containing any of these."
5396             if (type.isMatrix() || type.getBasicType() == EbtBlock || type.getBasicType() == EbtStruct)
5397                 error(loc, "cannot apply to a matrix, structure, or block", "component", "");
5398 
5399             // " It is a compile-time error to use component 1 or 3 as the beginning of a double or dvec2."
5400             if (type.getBasicType() == EbtDouble)
5401                 if (qualifier.layoutComponent & 1)
5402                     error(loc, "doubles cannot start on an odd-numbered component", "component", "");
5403         }
5404 
5405         switch (qualifier.storage) {
5406         case EvqVaryingIn:
5407         case EvqVaryingOut:
5408             if (type.getBasicType() == EbtBlock)
5409                 profileRequires(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, 440, E_GL_ARB_enhanced_layouts, "location qualifier on in/out block");
5410 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
5411             if (type.getQualifier().isTaskMemory())
5412                 error(loc, "cannot apply to taskNV in/out blocks", "location", "");
5413 #endif
5414             break;
5415         case EvqUniform:
5416         case EvqBuffer:
5417             if (type.getBasicType() == EbtBlock)
5418                 error(loc, "cannot apply to uniform or buffer block", "location", "");
5419             break;
5420 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
5421         case EvqPayloadNV:
5422         case EvqPayloadInNV:
5423         case EvqHitAttrNV:
5424         case EvqCallableDataNV:
5425         case EvqCallableDataInNV:
5426             break;
5427 #endif
5428         default:
5429             error(loc, "can only apply to uniform, buffer, in, or out storage qualifiers", "location", "");
5430             break;
5431         }
5432 
5433         bool typeCollision;
5434         int repeated = intermediate.addUsedLocation(qualifier, type, typeCollision);
5435         if (repeated >= 0 && ! typeCollision)
5436             error(loc, "overlapping use of location", "location", "%d", repeated);
5437         // "fragment-shader outputs ... if two variables are placed within the same
5438         // location, they must have the same underlying type (floating-point or integer)"
5439         if (typeCollision && language == EShLangFragment && qualifier.isPipeOutput())
5440             error(loc, "fragment outputs sharing the same location must be the same basic type", "location", "%d", repeated);
5441     }
5442 
5443     if (qualifier.hasXfbOffset() && qualifier.hasXfbBuffer()) {
5444         int repeated = intermediate.addXfbBufferOffset(type);
5445         if (repeated >= 0)
5446             error(loc, "overlapping offsets at", "xfb_offset", "offset %d in buffer %d", repeated, qualifier.layoutXfbBuffer);
5447 
5448         // "The offset must be a multiple of the size of the first component of the first
5449         // qualified variable or block member, or a compile-time error results. Further, if applied to an aggregate
5450         // containing a double, the offset must also be a multiple of 8..."
5451         if (type.containsBasicType(EbtDouble) && ! IsMultipleOfPow2(qualifier.layoutXfbOffset, 8))
5452             error(loc, "type contains double; xfb_offset must be a multiple of 8", "xfb_offset", "");
5453         // ..., if applied to an aggregate containing a float16_t, the offset must also be a multiple of 2..."
5454         else if (type.containsBasicType(EbtFloat16) && !IsMultipleOfPow2(qualifier.layoutXfbOffset, 2))
5455             error(loc, "type contains half float; xfb_offset must be a multiple of 2", "xfb_offset", "");
5456         else if (! IsMultipleOfPow2(qualifier.layoutXfbOffset, 4))
5457             error(loc, "must be a multiple of size of first component", "xfb_offset", "");
5458     }
5459 
5460     if (qualifier.hasXfbStride() && qualifier.hasXfbBuffer()) {
5461         if (! intermediate.setXfbBufferStride(qualifier.layoutXfbBuffer, qualifier.layoutXfbStride))
5462             error(loc, "all stride settings must match for xfb buffer", "xfb_stride", "%d", qualifier.layoutXfbBuffer);
5463     }
5464 
5465     if (qualifier.hasBinding()) {
5466         // Binding checking, from the spec:
5467         //
5468         // "If the binding point for any uniform or shader storage block instance is less than zero, or greater than or
5469         // equal to the implementation-dependent maximum number of uniform buffer bindings, a compile-time
5470         // error will occur. When the binding identifier is used with a uniform or shader storage block instanced as
5471         // an array of size N, all elements of the array from binding through binding + N - 1 must be within this
5472         // range."
5473         //
5474         if (! type.isOpaque() && type.getBasicType() != EbtBlock)
5475             error(loc, "requires block, or sampler/image, or atomic-counter type", "binding", "");
5476         if (type.getBasicType() == EbtSampler) {
5477             int lastBinding = qualifier.layoutBinding;
5478             if (type.isArray()) {
5479                 if (spvVersion.vulkan > 0)
5480                     lastBinding += 1;
5481                 else {
5482                     if (type.isSizedArray())
5483                         lastBinding += type.getCumulativeArraySize();
5484                     else {
5485                         lastBinding += 1;
5486                         if (spvVersion.vulkan == 0)
5487                             warn(loc, "assuming binding count of one for compile-time checking of binding numbers for unsized array", "[]", "");
5488                     }
5489                 }
5490             }
5491             if (spvVersion.vulkan == 0 && lastBinding >= resources.maxCombinedTextureImageUnits)
5492                 error(loc, "sampler binding not less than gl_MaxCombinedTextureImageUnits", "binding", type.isArray() ? "(using array)" : "");
5493         }
5494         if (type.getBasicType() == EbtAtomicUint) {
5495             if (qualifier.layoutBinding >= (unsigned int)resources.maxAtomicCounterBindings) {
5496                 error(loc, "atomic_uint binding is too large; see gl_MaxAtomicCounterBindings", "binding", "");
5497                 return;
5498             }
5499         }
5500     } else if (!intermediate.getAutoMapBindings()) {
5501         // some types require bindings
5502 
5503         // atomic_uint
5504         if (type.getBasicType() == EbtAtomicUint)
5505             error(loc, "layout(binding=X) is required", "atomic_uint", "");
5506 
5507         // SPIR-V
5508         if (spvVersion.spv > 0) {
5509             if (qualifier.isUniformOrBuffer()) {
5510                 if (type.getBasicType() == EbtBlock && !qualifier.layoutPushConstant &&
5511 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
5512                        !qualifier.layoutShaderRecordNV &&
5513 #endif
5514                        !qualifier.layoutAttachment &&
5515                        !qualifier.layoutBufferReference)
5516                     error(loc, "uniform/buffer blocks require layout(binding=X)", "binding", "");
5517                 else if (spvVersion.vulkan > 0 && type.getBasicType() == EbtSampler)
5518                     error(loc, "sampler/texture/image requires layout(binding=X)", "binding", "");
5519             }
5520         }
5521     }
5522 
5523     // some things can't have arrays of arrays
5524     if (type.isArrayOfArrays()) {
5525         if (spvVersion.vulkan > 0) {
5526             if (type.isOpaque() || (type.getQualifier().isUniformOrBuffer() && type.getBasicType() == EbtBlock))
5527                 warn(loc, "Generating SPIR-V array-of-arrays, but Vulkan only supports single array level for this resource", "[][]", "");
5528         }
5529     }
5530 
5531     // "The offset qualifier can only be used on block members of blocks..."
5532     if (qualifier.hasOffset()) {
5533         if (type.getBasicType() == EbtBlock)
5534             error(loc, "only applies to block members, not blocks", "offset", "");
5535     }
5536 
5537     // Image format
5538     if (qualifier.hasFormat()) {
5539         if (! type.isImage())
5540             error(loc, "only apply to images", TQualifier::getLayoutFormatString(qualifier.layoutFormat), "");
5541         else {
5542             if (type.getSampler().type == EbtFloat && qualifier.layoutFormat > ElfFloatGuard)
5543                 error(loc, "does not apply to floating point images", TQualifier::getLayoutFormatString(qualifier.layoutFormat), "");
5544             if (type.getSampler().type == EbtInt && (qualifier.layoutFormat < ElfFloatGuard || qualifier.layoutFormat > ElfIntGuard))
5545                 error(loc, "does not apply to signed integer images", TQualifier::getLayoutFormatString(qualifier.layoutFormat), "");
5546             if (type.getSampler().type == EbtUint && qualifier.layoutFormat < ElfIntGuard)
5547                 error(loc, "does not apply to unsigned integer images", TQualifier::getLayoutFormatString(qualifier.layoutFormat), "");
5548 
5549             if (profile == EEsProfile) {
5550                 // "Except for image variables qualified with the format qualifiers r32f, r32i, and r32ui, image variables must
5551                 // specify either memory qualifier readonly or the memory qualifier writeonly."
5552                 if (! (qualifier.layoutFormat == ElfR32f || qualifier.layoutFormat == ElfR32i || qualifier.layoutFormat == ElfR32ui)) {
5553                     if (! qualifier.readonly && ! qualifier.writeonly)
5554                         error(loc, "format requires readonly or writeonly memory qualifier", TQualifier::getLayoutFormatString(qualifier.layoutFormat), "");
5555                 }
5556             }
5557         }
5558     } else if (type.isImage() && ! qualifier.writeonly) {
5559         const char *explanation = "image variables not declared 'writeonly' and without a format layout qualifier";
5560         requireProfile(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, explanation);
5561         profileRequires(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, 0, E_GL_EXT_shader_image_load_formatted, explanation);
5562     }
5563 
5564     if (qualifier.layoutPushConstant && type.getBasicType() != EbtBlock)
5565         error(loc, "can only be used with a block", "push_constant", "");
5566 
5567     if (qualifier.layoutBufferReference && type.getBasicType() != EbtBlock)
5568         error(loc, "can only be used with a block", "buffer_reference", "");
5569 
5570 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
5571     if (qualifier.layoutShaderRecordNV && type.getBasicType() != EbtBlock)
5572         error(loc, "can only be used with a block", "shaderRecordNV", "");
5573 #endif
5574 
5575     // input attachment
5576     if (type.isSubpass()) {
5577         if (! qualifier.hasAttachment())
5578             error(loc, "requires an input_attachment_index layout qualifier", "subpass", "");
5579     } else {
5580         if (qualifier.hasAttachment())
5581             error(loc, "can only be used with a subpass", "input_attachment_index", "");
5582     }
5583 
5584     // specialization-constant id
5585     if (qualifier.hasSpecConstantId()) {
5586         if (type.getQualifier().storage != EvqConst)
5587             error(loc, "can only be applied to 'const'-qualified scalar", "constant_id", "");
5588         if (! type.isScalar())
5589             error(loc, "can only be applied to a scalar", "constant_id", "");
5590         switch (type.getBasicType())
5591         {
5592         case EbtInt8:
5593         case EbtUint8:
5594         case EbtInt16:
5595         case EbtUint16:
5596         case EbtInt:
5597         case EbtUint:
5598         case EbtInt64:
5599         case EbtUint64:
5600         case EbtBool:
5601         case EbtFloat:
5602         case EbtDouble:
5603         case EbtFloat16:
5604             break;
5605         default:
5606             error(loc, "cannot be applied to this type", "constant_id", "");
5607             break;
5608         }
5609     }
5610 }
5611 
5612 // Do layout error checking that can be done within a layout qualifier proper, not needing to know
5613 // if there are blocks, atomic counters, variables, etc.
layoutQualifierCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TQualifier & qualifier)5614 void TParseContext::layoutQualifierCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TQualifier& qualifier)
5615 {
5616     if (qualifier.storage == EvqShared && qualifier.hasLayout())
5617         error(loc, "cannot apply layout qualifiers to a shared variable", "shared", "");
5618 
5619     // "It is a compile-time error to use *component* without also specifying the location qualifier (order does not matter)."
5620     if (qualifier.hasComponent() && ! qualifier.hasLocation())
5621         error(loc, "must specify 'location' to use 'component'", "component", "");
5622 
5623     if (qualifier.hasAnyLocation()) {
5624 
5625         // "As with input layout qualifiers, all shaders except compute shaders
5626         // allow *location* layout qualifiers on output variable declarations,
5627         // output block declarations, and output block member declarations."
5628 
5629         switch (qualifier.storage) {
5630         case EvqVaryingIn:
5631         {
5632             const char* feature = "location qualifier on input";
5633             if (profile == EEsProfile && version < 310)
5634                 requireStage(loc, EShLangVertex, feature);
5635             else
5636                 requireStage(loc, (EShLanguageMask)~EShLangComputeMask, feature);
5637             if (language == EShLangVertex) {
5638                 const char* exts[2] = { E_GL_ARB_separate_shader_objects, E_GL_ARB_explicit_attrib_location };
5639                 profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 330, 2, exts, feature);
5640                 profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, feature);
5641             } else {
5642                 profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 410, E_GL_ARB_separate_shader_objects, feature);
5643                 profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 310, nullptr, feature);
5644             }
5645             break;
5646         }
5647         case EvqVaryingOut:
5648         {
5649             const char* feature = "location qualifier on output";
5650             if (profile == EEsProfile && version < 310)
5651                 requireStage(loc, EShLangFragment, feature);
5652             else
5653                 requireStage(loc, (EShLanguageMask)~EShLangComputeMask, feature);
5654             if (language == EShLangFragment) {
5655                 const char* exts[2] = { E_GL_ARB_separate_shader_objects, E_GL_ARB_explicit_attrib_location };
5656                 profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 330, 2, exts, feature);
5657                 profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, feature);
5658             } else {
5659                 profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 410, E_GL_ARB_separate_shader_objects, feature);
5660                 profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 310, nullptr, feature);
5661             }
5662             break;
5663         }
5664         case EvqUniform:
5665         case EvqBuffer:
5666         {
5667             const char* feature = "location qualifier on uniform or buffer";
5668             requireProfile(loc, EEsProfile | ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, feature);
5669             profileRequires(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, 430, nullptr, feature);
5670             profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 310, nullptr, feature);
5671             break;
5672         }
5673         default:
5674             break;
5675         }
5676         if (qualifier.hasIndex()) {
5677             if (qualifier.storage != EvqVaryingOut)
5678                 error(loc, "can only be used on an output", "index", "");
5679             if (! qualifier.hasLocation())
5680                 error(loc, "can only be used with an explicit location", "index", "");
5681         }
5682     }
5683 
5684     if (qualifier.hasBinding()) {
5685         if (! qualifier.isUniformOrBuffer() && !qualifier.isTaskMemory())
5686             error(loc, "requires uniform or buffer storage qualifier", "binding", "");
5687     }
5688     if (qualifier.hasStream()) {
5689         if (!qualifier.isPipeOutput())
5690             error(loc, "can only be used on an output", "stream", "");
5691     }
5692     if (qualifier.hasXfb()) {
5693         if (!qualifier.isPipeOutput())
5694             error(loc, "can only be used on an output", "xfb layout qualifier", "");
5695     }
5696     if (qualifier.hasUniformLayout()) {
5697         if (! qualifier.isUniformOrBuffer() && !qualifier.isTaskMemory()) {
5698             if (qualifier.hasMatrix() || qualifier.hasPacking())
5699                 error(loc, "matrix or packing qualifiers can only be used on a uniform or buffer", "layout", "");
5700             if (qualifier.hasOffset() || qualifier.hasAlign())
5701                 error(loc, "offset/align can only be used on a uniform or buffer", "layout", "");
5702         }
5703     }
5704     if (qualifier.layoutPushConstant) {
5705         if (qualifier.storage != EvqUniform)
5706             error(loc, "can only be used with a uniform", "push_constant", "");
5707         if (qualifier.hasSet())
5708             error(loc, "cannot be used with push_constant", "set", "");
5709     }
5710     if (qualifier.layoutBufferReference) {
5711         if (qualifier.storage != EvqBuffer)
5712             error(loc, "can only be used with buffer", "buffer_reference", "");
5713     }
5714 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
5715     if (qualifier.layoutShaderRecordNV) {
5716         if (qualifier.storage != EvqBuffer)
5717             error(loc, "can only be used with a buffer", "shaderRecordNV", "");
5718         if (qualifier.hasBinding())
5719             error(loc, "cannot be used with shaderRecordNV", "binding", "");
5720         if (qualifier.hasSet())
5721             error(loc, "cannot be used with shaderRecordNV", "set", "");
5722 
5723     }
5724     if (qualifier.storage == EvqHitAttrNV && qualifier.hasLayout()) {
5725         error(loc, "cannot apply layout qualifiers to hitAttributeNV variable", "hitAttributeNV", "");
5726     }
5727 #endif
5728 }
5729 
5730 // For places that can't have shader-level layout qualifiers
checkNoShaderLayouts(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TShaderQualifiers & shaderQualifiers)5731 void TParseContext::checkNoShaderLayouts(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TShaderQualifiers& shaderQualifiers)
5732 {
5733     const char* message = "can only apply to a standalone qualifier";
5734 
5735     if (shaderQualifiers.geometry != ElgNone)
5736         error(loc, message, TQualifier::getGeometryString(shaderQualifiers.geometry), "");
5737     if (shaderQualifiers.spacing != EvsNone)
5738         error(loc, message, TQualifier::getVertexSpacingString(shaderQualifiers.spacing), "");
5739     if (shaderQualifiers.order != EvoNone)
5740         error(loc, message, TQualifier::getVertexOrderString(shaderQualifiers.order), "");
5741     if (shaderQualifiers.pointMode)
5742         error(loc, message, "point_mode", "");
5743     if (shaderQualifiers.invocations != TQualifier::layoutNotSet)
5744         error(loc, message, "invocations", "");
5745     if (shaderQualifiers.earlyFragmentTests)
5746         error(loc, message, "early_fragment_tests", "");
5747     if (shaderQualifiers.postDepthCoverage)
5748         error(loc, message, "post_depth_coverage", "");
5749     for (int i = 0; i < 3; ++i) {
5750         if (shaderQualifiers.localSize[i] > 1)
5751             error(loc, message, "local_size", "");
5752         if (shaderQualifiers.localSizeSpecId[i] != TQualifier::layoutNotSet)
5753             error(loc, message, "local_size id", "");
5754     }
5755     if (shaderQualifiers.vertices != TQualifier::layoutNotSet) {
5756         if (language == EShLangGeometry
5757 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
5758             || language == EShLangMeshNV
5759 #endif
5760            )
5761             error(loc, message, "max_vertices", "");
5762         else if (language == EShLangTessControl)
5763             error(loc, message, "vertices", "");
5764         else
5765             assert(0);
5766     }
5767 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
5768     if (shaderQualifiers.primitives != TQualifier::layoutNotSet) {
5769         if (language == EShLangMeshNV)
5770             error(loc, message, "max_primitives", "");
5771         else
5772             assert(0);
5773     }
5774 #endif
5775     if (shaderQualifiers.blendEquation)
5776         error(loc, message, "blend equation", "");
5777     if (shaderQualifiers.numViews != TQualifier::layoutNotSet)
5778         error(loc, message, "num_views", "");
5779 }
5780 
5781 // Correct and/or advance an object's offset layout qualifier.
fixOffset(const TSourceLoc & loc,TSymbol & symbol)5782 void TParseContext::fixOffset(const TSourceLoc& loc, TSymbol& symbol)
5783 {
5784     const TQualifier& qualifier = symbol.getType().getQualifier();
5785     if (symbol.getType().getBasicType() == EbtAtomicUint) {
5786         if (qualifier.hasBinding() && (int)qualifier.layoutBinding < resources.maxAtomicCounterBindings) {
5787 
5788             // Set the offset
5789             int offset;
5790             if (qualifier.hasOffset())
5791                 offset = qualifier.layoutOffset;
5792             else
5793                 offset = atomicUintOffsets[qualifier.layoutBinding];
5794             symbol.getWritableType().getQualifier().layoutOffset = offset;
5795 
5796             // Check for overlap
5797             int numOffsets = 4;
5798             if (symbol.getType().isArray()) {
5799                 if (symbol.getType().isSizedArray() && !symbol.getType().getArraySizes()->isInnerUnsized())
5800                     numOffsets *= symbol.getType().getCumulativeArraySize();
5801                 else {
5802                     // "It is a compile-time error to declare an unsized array of atomic_uint."
5803                     error(loc, "array must be explicitly sized", "atomic_uint", "");
5804                 }
5805             }
5806             int repeated = intermediate.addUsedOffsets(qualifier.layoutBinding, offset, numOffsets);
5807             if (repeated >= 0)
5808                 error(loc, "atomic counters sharing the same offset:", "offset", "%d", repeated);
5809 
5810             // Bump the default offset
5811             atomicUintOffsets[qualifier.layoutBinding] = offset + numOffsets;
5812         }
5813     }
5814 }
5815 
5816 //
5817 // Look up a function name in the symbol table, and make sure it is a function.
5818 //
5819 // Return the function symbol if found, otherwise nullptr.
5820 //
findFunction(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TFunction & call,bool & builtIn)5821 const TFunction* TParseContext::findFunction(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TFunction& call, bool& builtIn)
5822 {
5823     const TFunction* function = nullptr;
5824 
5825     if (symbolTable.isFunctionNameVariable(call.getName())) {
5826         error(loc, "can't use function syntax on variable", call.getName().c_str(), "");
5827         return nullptr;
5828     }
5829 
5830     bool explicitTypesEnabled = extensionTurnedOn(E_GL_EXT_shader_explicit_arithmetic_types) ||
5831                                 extensionTurnedOn(E_GL_EXT_shader_explicit_arithmetic_types_int8) ||
5832                                 extensionTurnedOn(E_GL_EXT_shader_explicit_arithmetic_types_int16) ||
5833                                 extensionTurnedOn(E_GL_EXT_shader_explicit_arithmetic_types_int32) ||
5834                                 extensionTurnedOn(E_GL_EXT_shader_explicit_arithmetic_types_int64) ||
5835                                 extensionTurnedOn(E_GL_EXT_shader_explicit_arithmetic_types_float16) ||
5836                                 extensionTurnedOn(E_GL_EXT_shader_explicit_arithmetic_types_float32) ||
5837                                 extensionTurnedOn(E_GL_EXT_shader_explicit_arithmetic_types_float64);
5838 
5839     if (profile == EEsProfile || version < 120)
5840         function = findFunctionExact(loc, call, builtIn);
5841     else if (version < 400)
5842         function = findFunction120(loc, call, builtIn);
5843     else if (explicitTypesEnabled)
5844         function = findFunctionExplicitTypes(loc, call, builtIn);
5845     else
5846         function = findFunction400(loc, call, builtIn);
5847 
5848     return function;
5849 }
5850 
5851 // Function finding algorithm for ES and desktop 110.
findFunctionExact(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TFunction & call,bool & builtIn)5852 const TFunction* TParseContext::findFunctionExact(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TFunction& call, bool& builtIn)
5853 {
5854     TSymbol* symbol = symbolTable.find(call.getMangledName(), &builtIn);
5855     if (symbol == nullptr) {
5856         error(loc, "no matching overloaded function found", call.getName().c_str(), "");
5857 
5858         return nullptr;
5859     }
5860 
5861     return symbol->getAsFunction();
5862 }
5863 
5864 // Function finding algorithm for desktop versions 120 through 330.
findFunction120(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TFunction & call,bool & builtIn)5865 const TFunction* TParseContext::findFunction120(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TFunction& call, bool& builtIn)
5866 {
5867     // first, look for an exact match
5868     TSymbol* symbol = symbolTable.find(call.getMangledName(), &builtIn);
5869     if (symbol)
5870         return symbol->getAsFunction();
5871 
5872     // exact match not found, look through a list of overloaded functions of the same name
5873 
5874     // "If no exact match is found, then [implicit conversions] will be applied to find a match. Mismatched types
5875     // on input parameters (in or inout or default) must have a conversion from the calling argument type to the
5876     // formal parameter type. Mismatched types on output parameters (out or inout) must have a conversion
5877     // from the formal parameter type to the calling argument type.  When argument conversions are used to find
5878     // a match, it is a semantic error if there are multiple ways to apply these conversions to make the call match
5879     // more than one function."
5880 
5881     const TFunction* candidate = nullptr;
5882     TVector<const TFunction*> candidateList;
5883     symbolTable.findFunctionNameList(call.getMangledName(), candidateList, builtIn);
5884 
5885     for (auto it = candidateList.begin(); it != candidateList.end(); ++it) {
5886         const TFunction& function = *(*it);
5887 
5888         // to even be a potential match, number of arguments has to match
5889         if (call.getParamCount() != function.getParamCount())
5890             continue;
5891 
5892         bool possibleMatch = true;
5893         for (int i = 0; i < function.getParamCount(); ++i) {
5894             // same types is easy
5895             if (*function[i].type == *call[i].type)
5896                 continue;
5897 
5898             // We have a mismatch in type, see if it is implicitly convertible
5899 
5900             if (function[i].type->isArray() || call[i].type->isArray() ||
5901                 ! function[i].type->sameElementShape(*call[i].type))
5902                 possibleMatch = false;
5903             else {
5904                 // do direction-specific checks for conversion of basic type
5905                 if (function[i].type->getQualifier().isParamInput()) {
5906                     if (! intermediate.canImplicitlyPromote(call[i].type->getBasicType(), function[i].type->getBasicType()))
5907                         possibleMatch = false;
5908                 }
5909                 if (function[i].type->getQualifier().isParamOutput()) {
5910                     if (! intermediate.canImplicitlyPromote(function[i].type->getBasicType(), call[i].type->getBasicType()))
5911                         possibleMatch = false;
5912                 }
5913             }
5914             if (! possibleMatch)
5915                 break;
5916         }
5917         if (possibleMatch) {
5918             if (candidate) {
5919                 // our second match, meaning ambiguity
5920                 error(loc, "ambiguous function signature match: multiple signatures match under implicit type conversion", call.getName().c_str(), "");
5921             } else
5922                 candidate = &function;
5923         }
5924     }
5925 
5926     if (candidate == nullptr)
5927         error(loc, "no matching overloaded function found", call.getName().c_str(), "");
5928 
5929     return candidate;
5930 }
5931 
5932 // Function finding algorithm for desktop version 400 and above.
5933 //
5934 // "When function calls are resolved, an exact type match for all the arguments
5935 // is sought. If an exact match is found, all other functions are ignored, and
5936 // the exact match is used. If no exact match is found, then the implicit
5937 // conversions in section 4.1.10 Implicit Conversions will be applied to find
5938 // a match. Mismatched types on input parameters (in or inout or default) must
5939 // have a conversion from the calling argument type to the formal parameter type.
5940 // Mismatched types on output parameters (out or inout) must have a conversion
5941 // from the formal parameter type to the calling argument type.
5942 //
5943 // "If implicit conversions can be used to find more than one matching function,
5944 // a single best-matching function is sought. To determine a best match, the
5945 // conversions between calling argument and formal parameter types are compared
5946 // for each function argument and pair of matching functions. After these
5947 // comparisons are performed, each pair of matching functions are compared.
5948 // A function declaration A is considered a better match than function
5949 // declaration B if
5950 //
5951 //  * for at least one function argument, the conversion for that argument in A
5952 //    is better than the corresponding conversion in B; and
5953 //  * there is no function argument for which the conversion in B is better than
5954 //    the corresponding conversion in A.
5955 //
5956 // "If a single function declaration is considered a better match than every
5957 // other matching function declaration, it will be used. Otherwise, a
5958 // compile-time semantic error for an ambiguous overloaded function call occurs.
5959 //
5960 // "To determine whether the conversion for a single argument in one match is
5961 // better than that for another match, the following rules are applied, in order:
5962 //
5963 //  1. An exact match is better than a match involving any implicit conversion.
5964 //  2. A match involving an implicit conversion from float to double is better
5965 //     than a match involving any other implicit conversion.
5966 //  3. A match involving an implicit conversion from either int or uint to float
5967 //     is better than a match involving an implicit conversion from either int
5968 //     or uint to double.
5969 //
5970 // "If none of the rules above apply to a particular pair of conversions, neither
5971 // conversion is considered better than the other."
5972 //
findFunction400(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TFunction & call,bool & builtIn)5973 const TFunction* TParseContext::findFunction400(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TFunction& call, bool& builtIn)
5974 {
5975     // first, look for an exact match
5976     TSymbol* symbol = symbolTable.find(call.getMangledName(), &builtIn);
5977     if (symbol)
5978         return symbol->getAsFunction();
5979 
5980     // no exact match, use the generic selector, parameterized by the GLSL rules
5981 
5982     // create list of candidates to send
5983     TVector<const TFunction*> candidateList;
5984     symbolTable.findFunctionNameList(call.getMangledName(), candidateList, builtIn);
5985 
5986     // can 'from' convert to 'to'?
5987     const auto convertible = [this](const TType& from, const TType& to, TOperator, int) -> bool {
5988         if (from == to)
5989             return true;
5990         if (from.isArray() || to.isArray() || ! from.sameElementShape(to))
5991             return false;
5992         return intermediate.canImplicitlyPromote(from.getBasicType(), to.getBasicType());
5993     };
5994 
5995     // Is 'to2' a better conversion than 'to1'?
5996     // Ties should not be considered as better.
5997     // Assumes 'convertible' already said true.
5998     const auto better = [](const TType& from, const TType& to1, const TType& to2) -> bool {
5999         // 1. exact match
6000         if (from == to2)
6001             return from != to1;
6002         if (from == to1)
6003             return false;
6004 
6005         // 2. float -> double is better
6006         if (from.getBasicType() == EbtFloat) {
6007             if (to2.getBasicType() == EbtDouble && to1.getBasicType() != EbtDouble)
6008                 return true;
6009         }
6010 
6011         // 3. -> float is better than -> double
6012         return to2.getBasicType() == EbtFloat && to1.getBasicType() == EbtDouble;
6013     };
6014 
6015     // for ambiguity reporting
6016     bool tie = false;
6017 
6018     // send to the generic selector
6019     const TFunction* bestMatch = selectFunction(candidateList, call, convertible, better, tie);
6020 
6021     if (bestMatch == nullptr)
6022         error(loc, "no matching overloaded function found", call.getName().c_str(), "");
6023     else if (tie)
6024         error(loc, "ambiguous best function under implicit type conversion", call.getName().c_str(), "");
6025 
6026     return bestMatch;
6027 }
6028 
6029 // "To determine whether the conversion for a single argument in one match
6030 //  is better than that for another match, the conversion is assigned of the
6031 //  three ranks ordered from best to worst:
6032 //   1. Exact match: no conversion.
6033 //    2. Promotion: integral or floating-point promotion.
6034 //    3. Conversion: integral conversion, floating-point conversion,
6035 //       floating-integral conversion.
6036 //  A conversion C1 is better than a conversion C2 if the rank of C1 is
6037 //  better than the rank of C2."
findFunctionExplicitTypes(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TFunction & call,bool & builtIn)6038 const TFunction* TParseContext::findFunctionExplicitTypes(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TFunction& call, bool& builtIn)
6039 {
6040     // first, look for an exact match
6041     TSymbol* symbol = symbolTable.find(call.getMangledName(), &builtIn);
6042     if (symbol)
6043         return symbol->getAsFunction();
6044 
6045     // no exact match, use the generic selector, parameterized by the GLSL rules
6046 
6047     // create list of candidates to send
6048     TVector<const TFunction*> candidateList;
6049     symbolTable.findFunctionNameList(call.getMangledName(), candidateList, builtIn);
6050 
6051     // can 'from' convert to 'to'?
6052     const auto convertible = [this](const TType& from, const TType& to, TOperator, int) -> bool {
6053         if (from == to)
6054             return true;
6055         if (from.isArray() || to.isArray() || ! from.sameElementShape(to))
6056             return false;
6057         return intermediate.canImplicitlyPromote(from.getBasicType(), to.getBasicType());
6058     };
6059 
6060     // Is 'to2' a better conversion than 'to1'?
6061     // Ties should not be considered as better.
6062     // Assumes 'convertible' already said true.
6063     const auto better = [this](const TType& from, const TType& to1, const TType& to2) -> bool {
6064         // 1. exact match
6065         if (from == to2)
6066             return from != to1;
6067         if (from == to1)
6068             return false;
6069 
6070         // 2. Promotion (integral, floating-point) is better
6071         TBasicType from_type = from.getBasicType();
6072         TBasicType to1_type = to1.getBasicType();
6073         TBasicType to2_type = to2.getBasicType();
6074         bool isPromotion1 = (intermediate.isIntegralPromotion(from_type, to1_type) ||
6075                              intermediate.isFPPromotion(from_type, to1_type));
6076         bool isPromotion2 = (intermediate.isIntegralPromotion(from_type, to2_type) ||
6077                              intermediate.isFPPromotion(from_type, to2_type));
6078         if (isPromotion2)
6079             return !isPromotion1;
6080         if(isPromotion1)
6081             return false;
6082 
6083         // 3. Conversion (integral, floating-point , floating-integral)
6084         bool isConversion1 = (intermediate.isIntegralConversion(from_type, to1_type) ||
6085                               intermediate.isFPConversion(from_type, to1_type) ||
6086                               intermediate.isFPIntegralConversion(from_type, to1_type));
6087         bool isConversion2 = (intermediate.isIntegralConversion(from_type, to2_type) ||
6088                               intermediate.isFPConversion(from_type, to2_type) ||
6089                               intermediate.isFPIntegralConversion(from_type, to2_type));
6090 
6091         return isConversion2 && !isConversion1;
6092     };
6093 
6094     // for ambiguity reporting
6095     bool tie = false;
6096 
6097     // send to the generic selector
6098     const TFunction* bestMatch = selectFunction(candidateList, call, convertible, better, tie);
6099 
6100     if (bestMatch == nullptr)
6101         error(loc, "no matching overloaded function found", call.getName().c_str(), "");
6102     else if (tie)
6103         error(loc, "ambiguous best function under implicit type conversion", call.getName().c_str(), "");
6104 
6105     return bestMatch;
6106 }
6107 
6108 // When a declaration includes a type, but not a variable name, it can be
6109 // to establish defaults.
declareTypeDefaults(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TPublicType & publicType)6110 void TParseContext::declareTypeDefaults(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TPublicType& publicType)
6111 {
6112     if (publicType.basicType == EbtAtomicUint && publicType.qualifier.hasBinding() && publicType.qualifier.hasOffset()) {
6113         if (publicType.qualifier.layoutBinding >= (unsigned int)resources.maxAtomicCounterBindings) {
6114             error(loc, "atomic_uint binding is too large", "binding", "");
6115             return;
6116         }
6117         atomicUintOffsets[publicType.qualifier.layoutBinding] = publicType.qualifier.layoutOffset;
6118         return;
6119     }
6120 
6121     if (publicType.qualifier.hasLayout() && !publicType.qualifier.layoutBufferReference)
6122         warn(loc, "useless application of layout qualifier", "layout", "");
6123 }
6124 
6125 //
6126 // Do everything necessary to handle a variable (non-block) declaration.
6127 // Either redeclaring a variable, or making a new one, updating the symbol
6128 // table, and all error checking.
6129 //
6130 // Returns a subtree node that computes an initializer, if needed.
6131 // Returns nullptr if there is no code to execute for initialization.
6132 //
6133 // 'publicType' is the type part of the declaration (to the left)
6134 // 'arraySizes' is the arrayness tagged on the identifier (to the right)
6135 //
declareVariable(const TSourceLoc & loc,TString & identifier,const TPublicType & publicType,TArraySizes * arraySizes,TIntermTyped * initializer)6136 TIntermNode* TParseContext::declareVariable(const TSourceLoc& loc, TString& identifier, const TPublicType& publicType,
6137     TArraySizes* arraySizes, TIntermTyped* initializer)
6138 {
6139     // Make a fresh type that combines the characteristics from the individual
6140     // identifier syntax and the declaration-type syntax.
6141     TType type(publicType);
6142     type.transferArraySizes(arraySizes);
6143     type.copyArrayInnerSizes(publicType.arraySizes);
6144     arrayOfArrayVersionCheck(loc, type.getArraySizes());
6145 
6146     if (voidErrorCheck(loc, identifier, type.getBasicType()))
6147         return nullptr;
6148 
6149     if (initializer)
6150         rValueErrorCheck(loc, "initializer", initializer);
6151     else
6152         nonInitConstCheck(loc, identifier, type);
6153 
6154     samplerCheck(loc, type, identifier, initializer);
6155     atomicUintCheck(loc, type, identifier);
6156     transparentOpaqueCheck(loc, type, identifier);
6157 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
6158     accStructNVCheck(loc, type, identifier);
6159 #endif
6160 
6161     if (type.getQualifier().storage != EvqUniform && type.getQualifier().storage != EvqBuffer) {
6162         if (type.containsBasicType(EbtFloat16))
6163             requireFloat16Arithmetic(loc, "qualifier", "float16 types can only be in uniform block or buffer storage");
6164         if (type.contains16BitInt())
6165             requireInt16Arithmetic(loc, "qualifier", "(u)int16 types can only be in uniform block or buffer storage");
6166         if (type.contains8BitInt())
6167             requireInt8Arithmetic(loc, "qualifier", "(u)int8 types can only be in uniform block or buffer storage");
6168     }
6169 
6170     if (identifier != "gl_FragCoord" && (publicType.shaderQualifiers.originUpperLeft || publicType.shaderQualifiers.pixelCenterInteger))
6171         error(loc, "can only apply origin_upper_left and pixel_center_origin to gl_FragCoord", "layout qualifier", "");
6172     if (identifier != "gl_FragDepth" && publicType.shaderQualifiers.layoutDepth != EldNone)
6173         error(loc, "can only apply depth layout to gl_FragDepth", "layout qualifier", "");
6174 
6175     // Check for redeclaration of built-ins and/or attempting to declare a reserved name
6176     TSymbol* symbol = redeclareBuiltinVariable(loc, identifier, type.getQualifier(), publicType.shaderQualifiers);
6177     if (symbol == nullptr)
6178         reservedErrorCheck(loc, identifier);
6179 
6180     inheritGlobalDefaults(type.getQualifier());
6181 
6182     // Declare the variable
6183     if (type.isArray()) {
6184         // Check that implicit sizing is only where allowed.
6185         arraySizesCheck(loc, type.getQualifier(), type.getArraySizes(), initializer, false);
6186 
6187         if (! arrayQualifierError(loc, type.getQualifier()) && ! arrayError(loc, type))
6188             declareArray(loc, identifier, type, symbol);
6189 
6190         if (initializer) {
6191             profileRequires(loc, ENoProfile, 120, E_GL_3DL_array_objects, "initializer");
6192             profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, "initializer");
6193         }
6194     } else {
6195         // non-array case
6196         if (symbol == nullptr)
6197             symbol = declareNonArray(loc, identifier, type);
6198         else if (type != symbol->getType())
6199             error(loc, "cannot change the type of", "redeclaration", symbol->getName().c_str());
6200     }
6201 
6202     if (symbol == nullptr)
6203         return nullptr;
6204 
6205     // Deal with initializer
6206     TIntermNode* initNode = nullptr;
6207     if (symbol != nullptr && initializer) {
6208         TVariable* variable = symbol->getAsVariable();
6209         if (! variable) {
6210             error(loc, "initializer requires a variable, not a member", identifier.c_str(), "");
6211             return nullptr;
6212         }
6213         initNode = executeInitializer(loc, initializer, variable);
6214     }
6215 
6216     // look for errors in layout qualifier use
6217     layoutObjectCheck(loc, *symbol);
6218 
6219     // fix up
6220     fixOffset(loc, *symbol);
6221 
6222     if (symbol->getType().getBasicType() == EbtStruct) {
6223        fixXfbOffsets(symbol->getWritableType().getQualifier(),
6224                      *(symbol->getWritableType().getWritableStruct()));
6225     }
6226 
6227     return initNode;
6228 }
6229 
6230 // Pick up global defaults from the provide global defaults into dst.
inheritGlobalDefaults(TQualifier & dst) const6231 void TParseContext::inheritGlobalDefaults(TQualifier& dst) const
6232 {
6233     if (dst.storage == EvqVaryingOut) {
6234         if (! dst.hasStream() && language == EShLangGeometry)
6235             dst.layoutStream = globalOutputDefaults.layoutStream;
6236         if (! dst.hasXfbBuffer())
6237             dst.layoutXfbBuffer = globalOutputDefaults.layoutXfbBuffer;
6238     }
6239 }
6240 
6241 //
6242 // Make an internal-only variable whose name is for debug purposes only
6243 // and won't be searched for.  Callers will only use the return value to use
6244 // the variable, not the name to look it up.  It is okay if the name
6245 // is the same as other names; there won't be any conflict.
6246 //
makeInternalVariable(const char * name,const TType & type) const6247 TVariable* TParseContext::makeInternalVariable(const char* name, const TType& type) const
6248 {
6249     TString* nameString = NewPoolTString(name);
6250     TVariable* variable = new TVariable(nameString, type);
6251     symbolTable.makeInternalVariable(*variable);
6252 
6253     return variable;
6254 }
6255 
6256 //
6257 // Declare a non-array variable, the main point being there is no redeclaration
6258 // for resizing allowed.
6259 //
6260 // Return the successfully declared variable.
6261 //
declareNonArray(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TString & identifier,const TType & type)6262 TVariable* TParseContext::declareNonArray(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TString& identifier, const TType& type)
6263 {
6264     // make a new variable
6265     TVariable* variable = new TVariable(&identifier, type);
6266 
6267     ioArrayCheck(loc, type, identifier);
6268 
6269     // add variable to symbol table
6270     if (symbolTable.insert(*variable)) {
6271         if (symbolTable.atGlobalLevel())
6272             trackLinkage(*variable);
6273         return variable;
6274     }
6275 
6276     error(loc, "redefinition", variable->getName().c_str(), "");
6277     return nullptr;
6278 }
6279 
6280 //
6281 // Handle all types of initializers from the grammar.
6282 //
6283 // Returning nullptr just means there is no code to execute to handle the
6284 // initializer, which will, for example, be the case for constant initializers.
6285 //
executeInitializer(const TSourceLoc & loc,TIntermTyped * initializer,TVariable * variable)6286 TIntermNode* TParseContext::executeInitializer(const TSourceLoc& loc, TIntermTyped* initializer, TVariable* variable)
6287 {
6288     //
6289     // Identifier must be of type constant, a global, or a temporary, and
6290     // starting at version 120, desktop allows uniforms to have initializers.
6291     //
6292     TStorageQualifier qualifier = variable->getType().getQualifier().storage;
6293     if (! (qualifier == EvqTemporary || qualifier == EvqGlobal || qualifier == EvqConst ||
6294            (qualifier == EvqUniform && profile != EEsProfile && version >= 120))) {
6295         error(loc, " cannot initialize this type of qualifier ", variable->getType().getStorageQualifierString(), "");
6296         return nullptr;
6297     }
6298     arrayObjectCheck(loc, variable->getType(), "array initializer");
6299 
6300     //
6301     // If the initializer was from braces { ... }, we convert the whole subtree to a
6302     // constructor-style subtree, allowing the rest of the code to operate
6303     // identically for both kinds of initializers.
6304     //
6305     // Type can't be deduced from the initializer list, so a skeletal type to
6306     // follow has to be passed in.  Constness and specialization-constness
6307     // should be deduced bottom up, not dictated by the skeletal type.
6308     //
6309     TType skeletalType;
6310     skeletalType.shallowCopy(variable->getType());
6311     skeletalType.getQualifier().makeTemporary();
6312     initializer = convertInitializerList(loc, skeletalType, initializer);
6313     if (! initializer) {
6314         // error recovery; don't leave const without constant values
6315         if (qualifier == EvqConst)
6316             variable->getWritableType().getQualifier().makeTemporary();
6317         return nullptr;
6318     }
6319 
6320     // Fix outer arrayness if variable is unsized, getting size from the initializer
6321     if (initializer->getType().isSizedArray() && variable->getType().isUnsizedArray())
6322         variable->getWritableType().changeOuterArraySize(initializer->getType().getOuterArraySize());
6323 
6324     // Inner arrayness can also get set by an initializer
6325     if (initializer->getType().isArrayOfArrays() && variable->getType().isArrayOfArrays() &&
6326         initializer->getType().getArraySizes()->getNumDims() ==
6327            variable->getType().getArraySizes()->getNumDims()) {
6328         // adopt unsized sizes from the initializer's sizes
6329         for (int d = 1; d < variable->getType().getArraySizes()->getNumDims(); ++d) {
6330             if (variable->getType().getArraySizes()->getDimSize(d) == UnsizedArraySize) {
6331                 variable->getWritableType().getArraySizes()->setDimSize(d,
6332                     initializer->getType().getArraySizes()->getDimSize(d));
6333             }
6334         }
6335     }
6336 
6337     // Uniforms require a compile-time constant initializer
6338     if (qualifier == EvqUniform && ! initializer->getType().getQualifier().isFrontEndConstant()) {
6339         error(loc, "uniform initializers must be constant", "=", "'%s'", variable->getType().getCompleteString().c_str());
6340         variable->getWritableType().getQualifier().makeTemporary();
6341         return nullptr;
6342     }
6343     // Global consts require a constant initializer (specialization constant is okay)
6344     if (qualifier == EvqConst && symbolTable.atGlobalLevel() && ! initializer->getType().getQualifier().isConstant()) {
6345         error(loc, "global const initializers must be constant", "=", "'%s'", variable->getType().getCompleteString().c_str());
6346         variable->getWritableType().getQualifier().makeTemporary();
6347         return nullptr;
6348     }
6349 
6350     // Const variables require a constant initializer, depending on version
6351     if (qualifier == EvqConst) {
6352         if (! initializer->getType().getQualifier().isConstant()) {
6353             const char* initFeature = "non-constant initializer";
6354             requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, initFeature);
6355             profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 420, E_GL_ARB_shading_language_420pack, initFeature);
6356             variable->getWritableType().getQualifier().storage = EvqConstReadOnly;
6357             qualifier = EvqConstReadOnly;
6358         }
6359     } else {
6360         // Non-const global variables in ES need a const initializer.
6361         //
6362         // "In declarations of global variables with no storage qualifier or with a const
6363         // qualifier any initializer must be a constant expression."
6364         if (symbolTable.atGlobalLevel() && ! initializer->getType().getQualifier().isConstant()) {
6365             const char* initFeature = "non-constant global initializer (needs GL_EXT_shader_non_constant_global_initializers)";
6366             if (profile == EEsProfile) {
6367                 if (relaxedErrors() && ! extensionTurnedOn(E_GL_EXT_shader_non_constant_global_initializers))
6368                     warn(loc, "not allowed in this version", initFeature, "");
6369                 else
6370                     profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 0, E_GL_EXT_shader_non_constant_global_initializers, initFeature);
6371             }
6372         }
6373     }
6374 
6375     if (qualifier == EvqConst || qualifier == EvqUniform) {
6376         // Compile-time tagging of the variable with its constant value...
6377 
6378         initializer = intermediate.addConversion(EOpAssign, variable->getType(), initializer);
6379         if (! initializer || ! initializer->getType().getQualifier().isConstant() || variable->getType() != initializer->getType()) {
6380             error(loc, "non-matching or non-convertible constant type for const initializer",
6381                   variable->getType().getStorageQualifierString(), "");
6382             variable->getWritableType().getQualifier().makeTemporary();
6383             return nullptr;
6384         }
6385 
6386         // We either have a folded constant in getAsConstantUnion, or we have to use
6387         // the initializer's subtree in the AST to represent the computation of a
6388         // specialization constant.
6389         assert(initializer->getAsConstantUnion() || initializer->getType().getQualifier().isSpecConstant());
6390         if (initializer->getAsConstantUnion())
6391             variable->setConstArray(initializer->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray());
6392         else {
6393             // It's a specialization constant.
6394             variable->getWritableType().getQualifier().makeSpecConstant();
6395 
6396             // Keep the subtree that computes the specialization constant with the variable.
6397             // Later, a symbol node will adopt the subtree from the variable.
6398             variable->setConstSubtree(initializer);
6399         }
6400     } else {
6401         // normal assigning of a value to a variable...
6402         specializationCheck(loc, initializer->getType(), "initializer");
6403         TIntermSymbol* intermSymbol = intermediate.addSymbol(*variable, loc);
6404         TIntermTyped* initNode = intermediate.addAssign(EOpAssign, intermSymbol, initializer, loc);
6405         if (! initNode)
6406             assignError(loc, "=", intermSymbol->getCompleteString(), initializer->getCompleteString());
6407 
6408         return initNode;
6409     }
6410 
6411     return nullptr;
6412 }
6413 
6414 //
6415 // Reprocess any initializer-list (the  "{ ... }" syntax) parts of the
6416 // initializer.
6417 //
6418 // Need to hierarchically assign correct types and implicit
6419 // conversions. Will do this mimicking the same process used for
6420 // creating a constructor-style initializer, ensuring we get the
6421 // same form.  However, it has to in parallel walk the 'type'
6422 // passed in, as type cannot be deduced from an initializer list.
6423 //
convertInitializerList(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TType & type,TIntermTyped * initializer)6424 TIntermTyped* TParseContext::convertInitializerList(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TType& type, TIntermTyped* initializer)
6425 {
6426     // Will operate recursively.  Once a subtree is found that is constructor style,
6427     // everything below it is already good: Only the "top part" of the initializer
6428     // can be an initializer list, where "top part" can extend for several (or all) levels.
6429 
6430     // see if we have bottomed out in the tree within the initializer-list part
6431     TIntermAggregate* initList = initializer->getAsAggregate();
6432     if (! initList || initList->getOp() != EOpNull)
6433         return initializer;
6434 
6435     // Of the initializer-list set of nodes, need to process bottom up,
6436     // so recurse deep, then process on the way up.
6437 
6438     // Go down the tree here...
6439     if (type.isArray()) {
6440         // The type's array might be unsized, which could be okay, so base sizes on the size of the aggregate.
6441         // Later on, initializer execution code will deal with array size logic.
6442         TType arrayType;
6443         arrayType.shallowCopy(type);                     // sharing struct stuff is fine
6444         arrayType.copyArraySizes(*type.getArraySizes());  // but get a fresh copy of the array information, to edit below
6445 
6446         // edit array sizes to fill in unsized dimensions
6447         arrayType.changeOuterArraySize((int)initList->getSequence().size());
6448         TIntermTyped* firstInit = initList->getSequence()[0]->getAsTyped();
6449         if (arrayType.isArrayOfArrays() && firstInit->getType().isArray() &&
6450             arrayType.getArraySizes()->getNumDims() == firstInit->getType().getArraySizes()->getNumDims() + 1) {
6451             for (int d = 1; d < arrayType.getArraySizes()->getNumDims(); ++d) {
6452                 if (arrayType.getArraySizes()->getDimSize(d) == UnsizedArraySize)
6453                     arrayType.getArraySizes()->setDimSize(d, firstInit->getType().getArraySizes()->getDimSize(d - 1));
6454             }
6455         }
6456 
6457         TType elementType(arrayType, 0); // dereferenced type
6458         for (size_t i = 0; i < initList->getSequence().size(); ++i) {
6459             initList->getSequence()[i] = convertInitializerList(loc, elementType, initList->getSequence()[i]->getAsTyped());
6460             if (initList->getSequence()[i] == nullptr)
6461                 return nullptr;
6462         }
6463 
6464         return addConstructor(loc, initList, arrayType);
6465     } else if (type.isStruct()) {
6466         if (type.getStruct()->size() != initList->getSequence().size()) {
6467             error(loc, "wrong number of structure members", "initializer list", "");
6468             return nullptr;
6469         }
6470         for (size_t i = 0; i < type.getStruct()->size(); ++i) {
6471             initList->getSequence()[i] = convertInitializerList(loc, *(*type.getStruct())[i].type, initList->getSequence()[i]->getAsTyped());
6472             if (initList->getSequence()[i] == nullptr)
6473                 return nullptr;
6474         }
6475     } else if (type.isMatrix()) {
6476         if (type.getMatrixCols() != (int)initList->getSequence().size()) {
6477             error(loc, "wrong number of matrix columns:", "initializer list", type.getCompleteString().c_str());
6478             return nullptr;
6479         }
6480         TType vectorType(type, 0); // dereferenced type
6481         for (int i = 0; i < type.getMatrixCols(); ++i) {
6482             initList->getSequence()[i] = convertInitializerList(loc, vectorType, initList->getSequence()[i]->getAsTyped());
6483             if (initList->getSequence()[i] == nullptr)
6484                 return nullptr;
6485         }
6486     } else if (type.isVector()) {
6487         if (type.getVectorSize() != (int)initList->getSequence().size()) {
6488             error(loc, "wrong vector size (or rows in a matrix column):", "initializer list", type.getCompleteString().c_str());
6489             return nullptr;
6490         }
6491     } else {
6492         error(loc, "unexpected initializer-list type:", "initializer list", type.getCompleteString().c_str());
6493         return nullptr;
6494     }
6495 
6496     // Now that the subtree is processed, process this node as if the
6497     // initializer list is a set of arguments to a constructor.
6498     TIntermNode* emulatedConstructorArguments;
6499     if (initList->getSequence().size() == 1)
6500         emulatedConstructorArguments = initList->getSequence()[0];
6501     else
6502         emulatedConstructorArguments = initList;
6503     return addConstructor(loc, emulatedConstructorArguments, type);
6504 }
6505 
6506 //
6507 // Test for the correctness of the parameters passed to various constructor functions
6508 // and also convert them to the right data type, if allowed and required.
6509 //
6510 // 'node' is what to construct from.
6511 // 'type' is what type to construct.
6512 //
6513 // Returns nullptr for an error or the constructed node (aggregate or typed) for no error.
6514 //
addConstructor(const TSourceLoc & loc,TIntermNode * node,const TType & type)6515 TIntermTyped* TParseContext::addConstructor(const TSourceLoc& loc, TIntermNode* node, const TType& type)
6516 {
6517     if (node == nullptr || node->getAsTyped() == nullptr)
6518         return nullptr;
6519     rValueErrorCheck(loc, "constructor", node->getAsTyped());
6520 
6521     TIntermAggregate* aggrNode = node->getAsAggregate();
6522     TOperator op = intermediate.mapTypeToConstructorOp(type);
6523 
6524     // Combined texture-sampler constructors are completely semantic checked
6525     // in constructorTextureSamplerError()
6526     if (op == EOpConstructTextureSampler) {
6527         if (aggrNode->getSequence()[1]->getAsTyped()->getType().getSampler().shadow) {
6528             // Transfer depth into the texture (SPIR-V image) type, as a hint
6529             // for tools to know this texture/image is a depth image.
6530             aggrNode->getSequence()[0]->getAsTyped()->getWritableType().getSampler().shadow = true;
6531         }
6532         return intermediate.setAggregateOperator(aggrNode, op, type, loc);
6533     }
6534 
6535     TTypeList::const_iterator memberTypes;
6536     if (op == EOpConstructStruct)
6537         memberTypes = type.getStruct()->begin();
6538 
6539     TType elementType;
6540     if (type.isArray()) {
6541         TType dereferenced(type, 0);
6542         elementType.shallowCopy(dereferenced);
6543     } else
6544         elementType.shallowCopy(type);
6545 
6546     bool singleArg;
6547     if (aggrNode) {
6548         if (aggrNode->getOp() != EOpNull)
6549             singleArg = true;
6550         else
6551             singleArg = false;
6552     } else
6553         singleArg = true;
6554 
6555     TIntermTyped *newNode;
6556     if (singleArg) {
6557         // If structure constructor or array constructor is being called
6558         // for only one parameter inside the structure, we need to call constructAggregate function once.
6559         if (type.isArray())
6560             newNode = constructAggregate(node, elementType, 1, node->getLoc());
6561         else if (op == EOpConstructStruct)
6562             newNode = constructAggregate(node, *(*memberTypes).type, 1, node->getLoc());
6563         else
6564             newNode = constructBuiltIn(type, op, node->getAsTyped(), node->getLoc(), false);
6565 
6566         if (newNode && (type.isArray() || op == EOpConstructStruct))
6567             newNode = intermediate.setAggregateOperator(newNode, EOpConstructStruct, type, loc);
6568 
6569         return newNode;
6570     }
6571 
6572     //
6573     // Handle list of arguments.
6574     //
6575     TIntermSequence &sequenceVector = aggrNode->getSequence();    // Stores the information about the parameter to the constructor
6576     // if the structure constructor contains more than one parameter, then construct
6577     // each parameter
6578 
6579     int paramCount = 0;  // keeps track of the constructor parameter number being checked
6580 
6581     // for each parameter to the constructor call, check to see if the right type is passed or convert them
6582     // to the right type if possible (and allowed).
6583     // for structure constructors, just check if the right type is passed, no conversion is allowed.
6584     for (TIntermSequence::iterator p = sequenceVector.begin();
6585                                    p != sequenceVector.end(); p++, paramCount++) {
6586         if (type.isArray())
6587             newNode = constructAggregate(*p, elementType, paramCount+1, node->getLoc());
6588         else if (op == EOpConstructStruct)
6589             newNode = constructAggregate(*p, *(memberTypes[paramCount]).type, paramCount+1, node->getLoc());
6590         else
6591             newNode = constructBuiltIn(type, op, (*p)->getAsTyped(), node->getLoc(), true);
6592 
6593         if (newNode)
6594             *p = newNode;
6595         else
6596             return nullptr;
6597     }
6598 
6599     return intermediate.setAggregateOperator(aggrNode, op, type, loc);
6600 }
6601 
6602 // Function for constructor implementation. Calls addUnaryMath with appropriate EOp value
6603 // for the parameter to the constructor (passed to this function). Essentially, it converts
6604 // the parameter types correctly. If a constructor expects an int (like ivec2) and is passed a
6605 // float, then float is converted to int.
6606 //
6607 // Returns nullptr for an error or the constructed node.
6608 //
constructBuiltIn(const TType & type,TOperator op,TIntermTyped * node,const TSourceLoc & loc,bool subset)6609 TIntermTyped* TParseContext::constructBuiltIn(const TType& type, TOperator op, TIntermTyped* node, const TSourceLoc& loc,
6610     bool subset)
6611 {
6612     // If we are changing a matrix in both domain of basic type and to a non matrix,
6613     // do the shape change first (by default, below, basic type is changed before shape).
6614     // This avoids requesting a matrix of a new type that is going to be discarded anyway.
6615     // TODO: This could be generalized to more type combinations, but that would require
6616     // more extensive testing and full algorithm rework. For now, the need to do two changes makes
6617     // the recursive call work, and avoids the most aggregious case of creating integer matrices.
6618     if (node->getType().isMatrix() && (type.isScalar() || type.isVector()) &&
6619             type.isFloatingDomain() != node->getType().isFloatingDomain()) {
6620         TType transitionType(node->getBasicType(), glslang::EvqTemporary, type.getVectorSize(), 0, 0, node->isVector());
6621         TOperator transitionOp = intermediate.mapTypeToConstructorOp(transitionType);
6622         node = constructBuiltIn(transitionType, transitionOp, node, loc, false);
6623     }
6624 
6625     TIntermTyped* newNode;
6626     TOperator basicOp;
6627 
6628     //
6629     // First, convert types as needed.
6630     //
6631     switch (op) {
6632     case EOpConstructVec2:
6633     case EOpConstructVec3:
6634     case EOpConstructVec4:
6635     case EOpConstructMat2x2:
6636     case EOpConstructMat2x3:
6637     case EOpConstructMat2x4:
6638     case EOpConstructMat3x2:
6639     case EOpConstructMat3x3:
6640     case EOpConstructMat3x4:
6641     case EOpConstructMat4x2:
6642     case EOpConstructMat4x3:
6643     case EOpConstructMat4x4:
6644     case EOpConstructFloat:
6645         basicOp = EOpConstructFloat;
6646         break;
6647 
6648     case EOpConstructDVec2:
6649     case EOpConstructDVec3:
6650     case EOpConstructDVec4:
6651     case EOpConstructDMat2x2:
6652     case EOpConstructDMat2x3:
6653     case EOpConstructDMat2x4:
6654     case EOpConstructDMat3x2:
6655     case EOpConstructDMat3x3:
6656     case EOpConstructDMat3x4:
6657     case EOpConstructDMat4x2:
6658     case EOpConstructDMat4x3:
6659     case EOpConstructDMat4x4:
6660     case EOpConstructDouble:
6661         basicOp = EOpConstructDouble;
6662         break;
6663 
6664     case EOpConstructF16Vec2:
6665     case EOpConstructF16Vec3:
6666     case EOpConstructF16Vec4:
6667     case EOpConstructF16Mat2x2:
6668     case EOpConstructF16Mat2x3:
6669     case EOpConstructF16Mat2x4:
6670     case EOpConstructF16Mat3x2:
6671     case EOpConstructF16Mat3x3:
6672     case EOpConstructF16Mat3x4:
6673     case EOpConstructF16Mat4x2:
6674     case EOpConstructF16Mat4x3:
6675     case EOpConstructF16Mat4x4:
6676     case EOpConstructFloat16:
6677         basicOp = EOpConstructFloat16;
6678         break;
6679 
6680     case EOpConstructI8Vec2:
6681     case EOpConstructI8Vec3:
6682     case EOpConstructI8Vec4:
6683     case EOpConstructInt8:
6684         basicOp = EOpConstructInt8;
6685         break;
6686 
6687     case EOpConstructU8Vec2:
6688     case EOpConstructU8Vec3:
6689     case EOpConstructU8Vec4:
6690     case EOpConstructUint8:
6691         basicOp = EOpConstructUint8;
6692         break;
6693 
6694     case EOpConstructI16Vec2:
6695     case EOpConstructI16Vec3:
6696     case EOpConstructI16Vec4:
6697     case EOpConstructInt16:
6698         basicOp = EOpConstructInt16;
6699         break;
6700 
6701     case EOpConstructU16Vec2:
6702     case EOpConstructU16Vec3:
6703     case EOpConstructU16Vec4:
6704     case EOpConstructUint16:
6705         basicOp = EOpConstructUint16;
6706         break;
6707 
6708     case EOpConstructIVec2:
6709     case EOpConstructIVec3:
6710     case EOpConstructIVec4:
6711     case EOpConstructInt:
6712         basicOp = EOpConstructInt;
6713         break;
6714 
6715     case EOpConstructUVec2:
6716     case EOpConstructUVec3:
6717     case EOpConstructUVec4:
6718     case EOpConstructUint:
6719         basicOp = EOpConstructUint;
6720         break;
6721 
6722     case EOpConstructI64Vec2:
6723     case EOpConstructI64Vec3:
6724     case EOpConstructI64Vec4:
6725     case EOpConstructInt64:
6726         basicOp = EOpConstructInt64;
6727         break;
6728 
6729     case EOpConstructUint64:
6730         if (type.isScalar() && node->getType().getBasicType() == EbtReference) {
6731             TIntermUnary* newNode = intermediate.addUnaryNode(EOpConvPtrToUint64, node, node->getLoc(), type);
6732             return newNode;
6733         }
6734         // fall through
6735     case EOpConstructU64Vec2:
6736     case EOpConstructU64Vec3:
6737     case EOpConstructU64Vec4:
6738         basicOp = EOpConstructUint64;
6739         break;
6740 
6741     case EOpConstructBVec2:
6742     case EOpConstructBVec3:
6743     case EOpConstructBVec4:
6744     case EOpConstructBool:
6745         basicOp = EOpConstructBool;
6746         break;
6747 
6748     case EOpConstructNonuniform:
6749         node->getWritableType().getQualifier().nonUniform = true;
6750         return node;
6751         break;
6752 
6753     case EOpConstructReference:
6754         // construct reference from reference
6755         if (node->getType().getBasicType() == EbtReference) {
6756             newNode = intermediate.addUnaryNode(EOpConstructReference, node, node->getLoc(), type);
6757             return newNode;
6758         // construct reference from uint64
6759         } else if (node->getType().isScalar() && node->getType().getBasicType() == EbtUint64) {
6760             TIntermUnary* newNode = intermediate.addUnaryNode(EOpConvUint64ToPtr, node, node->getLoc(), type);
6761             return newNode;
6762         } else {
6763             return nullptr;
6764         }
6765 
6766     default:
6767         error(loc, "unsupported construction", "", "");
6768 
6769         return nullptr;
6770     }
6771     newNode = intermediate.addUnaryMath(basicOp, node, node->getLoc());
6772     if (newNode == nullptr) {
6773         error(loc, "can't convert", "constructor", "");
6774         return nullptr;
6775     }
6776 
6777     //
6778     // Now, if there still isn't an operation to do the construction, and we need one, add one.
6779     //
6780 
6781     // Otherwise, skip out early.
6782     if (subset || (newNode != node && newNode->getType() == type))
6783         return newNode;
6784 
6785     // setAggregateOperator will insert a new node for the constructor, as needed.
6786     return intermediate.setAggregateOperator(newNode, op, type, loc);
6787 }
6788 
6789 // This function tests for the type of the parameters to the structure or array constructor. Raises
6790 // an error message if the expected type does not match the parameter passed to the constructor.
6791 //
6792 // Returns nullptr for an error or the input node itself if the expected and the given parameter types match.
6793 //
constructAggregate(TIntermNode * node,const TType & type,int paramCount,const TSourceLoc & loc)6794 TIntermTyped* TParseContext::constructAggregate(TIntermNode* node, const TType& type, int paramCount, const TSourceLoc& loc)
6795 {
6796     TIntermTyped* converted = intermediate.addConversion(EOpConstructStruct, type, node->getAsTyped());
6797     if (! converted || converted->getType() != type) {
6798         error(loc, "", "constructor", "cannot convert parameter %d from '%s' to '%s'", paramCount,
6799               node->getAsTyped()->getType().getCompleteString().c_str(), type.getCompleteString().c_str());
6800 
6801         return nullptr;
6802     }
6803 
6804     return converted;
6805 }
6806 
6807 //
6808 // Do everything needed to add an interface block.
6809 //
declareBlock(const TSourceLoc & loc,TTypeList & typeList,const TString * instanceName,TArraySizes * arraySizes)6810 void TParseContext::declareBlock(const TSourceLoc& loc, TTypeList& typeList, const TString* instanceName,
6811     TArraySizes* arraySizes)
6812 {
6813     blockStageIoCheck(loc, currentBlockQualifier);
6814     blockQualifierCheck(loc, currentBlockQualifier, instanceName != nullptr);
6815     if (arraySizes != nullptr) {
6816         arraySizesCheck(loc, currentBlockQualifier, arraySizes, nullptr, false);
6817         arrayOfArrayVersionCheck(loc, arraySizes);
6818         if (arraySizes->getNumDims() > 1)
6819             requireProfile(loc, ~EEsProfile, "array-of-array of block");
6820     }
6821 
6822     // fix and check for member storage qualifiers and types that don't belong within a block
6823     for (unsigned int member = 0; member < typeList.size(); ++member) {
6824         TType& memberType = *typeList[member].type;
6825         TQualifier& memberQualifier = memberType.getQualifier();
6826         const TSourceLoc& memberLoc = typeList[member].loc;
6827         globalQualifierFixCheck(memberLoc, memberQualifier);
6828         if (memberQualifier.storage != EvqTemporary && memberQualifier.storage != EvqGlobal && memberQualifier.storage != currentBlockQualifier.storage)
6829             error(memberLoc, "member storage qualifier cannot contradict block storage qualifier", memberType.getFieldName().c_str(), "");
6830         memberQualifier.storage = currentBlockQualifier.storage;
6831 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
6832         if (currentBlockQualifier.perPrimitiveNV)
6833             memberQualifier.perPrimitiveNV = currentBlockQualifier.perPrimitiveNV;
6834         if (currentBlockQualifier.perViewNV)
6835             memberQualifier.perViewNV = currentBlockQualifier.perViewNV;
6836         if (currentBlockQualifier.perTaskNV)
6837             memberQualifier.perTaskNV = currentBlockQualifier.perTaskNV;
6838 #endif
6839         if ((currentBlockQualifier.storage == EvqUniform || currentBlockQualifier.storage == EvqBuffer) && (memberQualifier.isInterpolation() || memberQualifier.isAuxiliary()))
6840             error(memberLoc, "member of uniform or buffer block cannot have an auxiliary or interpolation qualifier", memberType.getFieldName().c_str(), "");
6841         if (memberType.isArray())
6842             arraySizesCheck(memberLoc, currentBlockQualifier, memberType.getArraySizes(), nullptr, member == typeList.size() - 1);
6843         if (memberQualifier.hasOffset()) {
6844             if (spvVersion.spv == 0) {
6845                 requireProfile(memberLoc, ~EEsProfile, "offset on block member");
6846                 profileRequires(memberLoc, ~EEsProfile, 440, E_GL_ARB_enhanced_layouts, "offset on block member");
6847             }
6848         }
6849 
6850         if (memberType.containsOpaque())
6851             error(memberLoc, "member of block cannot be or contain a sampler, image, or atomic_uint type", typeList[member].type->getFieldName().c_str(), "");
6852     }
6853 
6854     // This might be a redeclaration of a built-in block.  If so, redeclareBuiltinBlock() will
6855     // do all the rest.
6856     if (! symbolTable.atBuiltInLevel() && builtInName(*blockName)) {
6857         redeclareBuiltinBlock(loc, typeList, *blockName, instanceName, arraySizes);
6858         return;
6859     }
6860 
6861     // Not a redeclaration of a built-in; check that all names are user names.
6862     reservedErrorCheck(loc, *blockName);
6863     if (instanceName)
6864         reservedErrorCheck(loc, *instanceName);
6865     for (unsigned int member = 0; member < typeList.size(); ++member)
6866         reservedErrorCheck(typeList[member].loc, typeList[member].type->getFieldName());
6867 
6868     // Make default block qualification, and adjust the member qualifications
6869 
6870     TQualifier defaultQualification;
6871     switch (currentBlockQualifier.storage) {
6872     case EvqUniform:    defaultQualification = globalUniformDefaults;    break;
6873     case EvqBuffer:     defaultQualification = globalBufferDefaults;     break;
6874     case EvqVaryingIn:  defaultQualification = globalInputDefaults;      break;
6875     case EvqVaryingOut: defaultQualification = globalOutputDefaults;     break;
6876     default:            defaultQualification.clear();                    break;
6877     }
6878 
6879     // Special case for "push_constant uniform", which has a default of std430,
6880     // contrary to normal uniform defaults, and can't have a default tracked for it.
6881     if ((currentBlockQualifier.layoutPushConstant && !currentBlockQualifier.hasPacking())
6882 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
6883         || (currentBlockQualifier.layoutShaderRecordNV && !currentBlockQualifier.hasPacking())
6884 #endif
6885        )
6886         currentBlockQualifier.layoutPacking = ElpStd430;
6887 
6888 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
6889     // Special case for "taskNV in/out", which has a default of std430,
6890     if (currentBlockQualifier.perTaskNV && !currentBlockQualifier.hasPacking())
6891         currentBlockQualifier.layoutPacking = ElpStd430;
6892 #endif
6893 
6894     // fix and check for member layout qualifiers
6895 
6896     mergeObjectLayoutQualifiers(defaultQualification, currentBlockQualifier, true);
6897 
6898     // "The align qualifier can only be used on blocks or block members, and only for blocks declared with std140 or std430 layouts."
6899     if (currentBlockQualifier.hasAlign()) {
6900         if (defaultQualification.layoutPacking != ElpStd140 &&
6901             defaultQualification.layoutPacking != ElpStd430 &&
6902             defaultQualification.layoutPacking != ElpScalar) {
6903             error(loc, "can only be used with std140, std430, or scalar layout packing", "align", "");
6904             defaultQualification.layoutAlign = -1;
6905         }
6906     }
6907 
6908     bool memberWithLocation = false;
6909     bool memberWithoutLocation = false;
6910 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
6911     bool memberWithPerViewQualifier = false;
6912 #endif
6913     for (unsigned int member = 0; member < typeList.size(); ++member) {
6914         TQualifier& memberQualifier = typeList[member].type->getQualifier();
6915         const TSourceLoc& memberLoc = typeList[member].loc;
6916         if (memberQualifier.hasStream()) {
6917             if (defaultQualification.layoutStream != memberQualifier.layoutStream)
6918                 error(memberLoc, "member cannot contradict block", "stream", "");
6919         }
6920 
6921         // "This includes a block's inheritance of the
6922         // current global default buffer, a block member's inheritance of the block's
6923         // buffer, and the requirement that any *xfb_buffer* declared on a block
6924         // member must match the buffer inherited from the block."
6925         if (memberQualifier.hasXfbBuffer()) {
6926             if (defaultQualification.layoutXfbBuffer != memberQualifier.layoutXfbBuffer)
6927                 error(memberLoc, "member cannot contradict block (or what block inherited from global)", "xfb_buffer", "");
6928         }
6929 
6930         if (memberQualifier.hasPacking())
6931             error(memberLoc, "member of block cannot have a packing layout qualifier", typeList[member].type->getFieldName().c_str(), "");
6932         if (memberQualifier.hasLocation()) {
6933             const char* feature = "location on block member";
6934             switch (currentBlockQualifier.storage) {
6935             case EvqVaryingIn:
6936             case EvqVaryingOut:
6937                 requireProfile(memberLoc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile | EEsProfile, feature);
6938                 profileRequires(memberLoc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, 440, E_GL_ARB_enhanced_layouts, feature);
6939                 profileRequires(memberLoc, EEsProfile, 320, Num_AEP_shader_io_blocks, AEP_shader_io_blocks, feature);
6940                 memberWithLocation = true;
6941                 break;
6942             default:
6943                 error(memberLoc, "can only use in an in/out block", feature, "");
6944                 break;
6945             }
6946         } else
6947             memberWithoutLocation = true;
6948 
6949         // "The offset qualifier can only be used on block members of blocks declared with std140 or std430 layouts."
6950         // "The align qualifier can only be used on blocks or block members, and only for blocks declared with std140 or std430 layouts."
6951         if (memberQualifier.hasAlign() || memberQualifier.hasOffset()) {
6952             if (defaultQualification.layoutPacking != ElpStd140 &&
6953                 defaultQualification.layoutPacking != ElpStd430 &&
6954                 defaultQualification.layoutPacking != ElpScalar)
6955                 error(memberLoc, "can only be used with std140, std430, or scalar layout packing", "offset/align", "");
6956         }
6957 
6958 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
6959         if (memberQualifier.isPerView()) {
6960             memberWithPerViewQualifier = true;
6961         }
6962 #endif
6963 
6964         TQualifier newMemberQualification = defaultQualification;
6965         mergeQualifiers(memberLoc, newMemberQualification, memberQualifier, false);
6966         memberQualifier = newMemberQualification;
6967     }
6968 
6969     layoutMemberLocationArrayCheck(loc, memberWithLocation, arraySizes);
6970 
6971     // Ensure that the block has an XfbBuffer assigned. This is needed
6972     // because if the block has a XfbOffset assigned, then it is
6973     // assumed that it has implicitly assigned the current global
6974     // XfbBuffer, and because it's members need to be assigned a
6975     // XfbOffset if they lack it.
6976     if (currentBlockQualifier.storage == EvqVaryingOut && globalOutputDefaults.hasXfbBuffer()) {
6977        if (!currentBlockQualifier.hasXfbBuffer() && currentBlockQualifier.hasXfbOffset())
6978           currentBlockQualifier.layoutXfbBuffer = globalOutputDefaults.layoutXfbBuffer;
6979     }
6980 
6981     // Process the members
6982     fixBlockLocations(loc, currentBlockQualifier, typeList, memberWithLocation, memberWithoutLocation);
6983     fixXfbOffsets(currentBlockQualifier, typeList);
6984     fixBlockUniformOffsets(currentBlockQualifier, typeList);
6985     for (unsigned int member = 0; member < typeList.size(); ++member)
6986         layoutTypeCheck(typeList[member].loc, *typeList[member].type);
6987 
6988 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
6989     if (memberWithPerViewQualifier) {
6990         for (unsigned int member = 0; member < typeList.size(); ++member) {
6991             resizeMeshViewDimension(typeList[member].loc, *typeList[member].type);
6992         }
6993     }
6994 #endif
6995 
6996     // reverse merge, so that currentBlockQualifier now has all layout information
6997     // (can't use defaultQualification directly, it's missing other non-layout-default-class qualifiers)
6998     mergeObjectLayoutQualifiers(currentBlockQualifier, defaultQualification, true);
6999 
7000     //
7001     // Build and add the interface block as a new type named 'blockName'
7002     //
7003 
7004     TType blockType(&typeList, *blockName, currentBlockQualifier);
7005     if (arraySizes != nullptr)
7006         blockType.transferArraySizes(arraySizes);
7007     else
7008         ioArrayCheck(loc, blockType, instanceName ? *instanceName : *blockName);
7009 
7010     if (currentBlockQualifier.layoutBufferReference) {
7011 
7012         if (currentBlockQualifier.storage != EvqBuffer)
7013             error(loc, "can only be used with buffer", "buffer_reference", "");
7014 
7015         // Create the block reference type. If it was forward-declared, detect that
7016         // as a referent struct type with no members. Replace the referent type with
7017         // blockType.
7018         TType blockNameType(EbtReference, blockType, *blockName);
7019         TVariable* blockNameVar = new TVariable(blockName, blockNameType, true);
7020         if (! symbolTable.insert(*blockNameVar)) {
7021             TSymbol* existingName = symbolTable.find(*blockName);
7022             if (existingName->getType().getBasicType() == EbtReference &&
7023                 existingName->getType().getReferentType()->getStruct() &&
7024                 existingName->getType().getReferentType()->getStruct()->size() == 0 &&
7025                 existingName->getType().getQualifier().storage == blockType.getQualifier().storage) {
7026                 existingName->getType().getReferentType()->deepCopy(blockType);
7027             } else {
7028                 error(loc, "block name cannot be redefined", blockName->c_str(), "");
7029             }
7030         }
7031         if (!instanceName) {
7032             return;
7033         }
7034     } else {
7035         //
7036         // Don't make a user-defined type out of block name; that will cause an error
7037         // if the same block name gets reused in a different interface.
7038         //
7039         // "Block names have no other use within a shader
7040         // beyond interface matching; it is a compile-time error to use a block name at global scope for anything
7041         // other than as a block name (e.g., use of a block name for a global variable name or function name is
7042         // currently reserved)."
7043         //
7044         // Use the symbol table to prevent normal reuse of the block's name, as a variable entry,
7045         // whose type is EbtBlock, but without all the structure; that will come from the type
7046         // the instances point to.
7047         //
7048         TType blockNameType(EbtBlock, blockType.getQualifier().storage);
7049         TVariable* blockNameVar = new TVariable(blockName, blockNameType);
7050         if (! symbolTable.insert(*blockNameVar)) {
7051             TSymbol* existingName = symbolTable.find(*blockName);
7052             if (existingName->getType().getBasicType() == EbtBlock) {
7053                 if (existingName->getType().getQualifier().storage == blockType.getQualifier().storage) {
7054                     error(loc, "Cannot reuse block name within the same interface:", blockName->c_str(), blockType.getStorageQualifierString());
7055                     return;
7056                 }
7057             } else {
7058                 error(loc, "block name cannot redefine a non-block name", blockName->c_str(), "");
7059                 return;
7060             }
7061         }
7062     }
7063 
7064     // Add the variable, as anonymous or named instanceName.
7065     // Make an anonymous variable if no name was provided.
7066     if (! instanceName)
7067         instanceName = NewPoolTString("");
7068 
7069     TVariable& variable = *new TVariable(instanceName, blockType);
7070     if (! symbolTable.insert(variable)) {
7071         if (*instanceName == "")
7072             error(loc, "nameless block contains a member that already has a name at global scope", blockName->c_str(), "");
7073         else
7074             error(loc, "block instance name redefinition", variable.getName().c_str(), "");
7075 
7076         return;
7077     }
7078 
7079     // Check for general layout qualifier errors
7080     layoutObjectCheck(loc, variable);
7081 
7082     // fix up
7083     if (isIoResizeArray(blockType)) {
7084         ioArraySymbolResizeList.push_back(&variable);
7085         checkIoArraysConsistency(loc, true, blockType.getQualifier().isPerPrimitive());
7086     } else
7087         fixIoArraySize(loc, variable.getWritableType());
7088 
7089     // Save it in the AST for linker use.
7090     trackLinkage(variable);
7091 }
7092 
7093 // Do all block-declaration checking regarding the combination of in/out/uniform/buffer
7094 // with a particular stage.
blockStageIoCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TQualifier & qualifier)7095 void TParseContext::blockStageIoCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TQualifier& qualifier)
7096 {
7097     switch (qualifier.storage) {
7098     case EvqUniform:
7099         profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, "uniform block");
7100         profileRequires(loc, ENoProfile, 140, nullptr, "uniform block");
7101         if (currentBlockQualifier.layoutPacking == ElpStd430 && ! currentBlockQualifier.layoutPushConstant)
7102             requireExtensions(loc, 1, &E_GL_EXT_scalar_block_layout, "std430 requires the buffer storage qualifier");
7103         break;
7104     case EvqBuffer:
7105         requireProfile(loc, EEsProfile | ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, "buffer block");
7106         profileRequires(loc, ECoreProfile | ECompatibilityProfile, 430, nullptr, "buffer block");
7107         profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 310, nullptr, "buffer block");
7108         break;
7109     case EvqVaryingIn:
7110         profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 150, E_GL_ARB_separate_shader_objects, "input block");
7111         // It is a compile-time error to have an input block in a vertex shader or an output block in a fragment shader
7112         // "Compute shaders do not permit user-defined input variables..."
7113         requireStage(loc, (EShLanguageMask)(EShLangTessControlMask|EShLangTessEvaluationMask|EShLangGeometryMask|EShLangFragmentMask
7114 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
7115                                             |EShLangMeshNVMask
7116 #endif
7117                                            ), "input block");
7118         if (language == EShLangFragment) {
7119             profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 320, Num_AEP_shader_io_blocks, AEP_shader_io_blocks, "fragment input block");
7120         }
7121 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
7122         else if (language == EShLangMeshNV && ! qualifier.isTaskMemory()) {
7123             error(loc, "input blocks cannot be used in a mesh shader", "out", "");
7124         }
7125 #endif
7126         break;
7127     case EvqVaryingOut:
7128         profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 150, E_GL_ARB_separate_shader_objects, "output block");
7129         requireStage(loc, (EShLanguageMask)(EShLangVertexMask|EShLangTessControlMask|EShLangTessEvaluationMask|EShLangGeometryMask
7130 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
7131                                             |EShLangMeshNVMask|EShLangTaskNVMask
7132 #endif
7133                                            ), "output block");
7134         // ES 310 can have a block before shader_io is turned on, so skip this test for built-ins
7135         if (language == EShLangVertex && ! parsingBuiltins) {
7136             profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 320, Num_AEP_shader_io_blocks, AEP_shader_io_blocks, "vertex output block");
7137         }
7138 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
7139         else if (language == EShLangMeshNV && qualifier.isTaskMemory()) {
7140             error(loc, "can only use on input blocks in mesh shader", "taskNV", "");
7141         }
7142         else if (language == EShLangTaskNV && ! qualifier.isTaskMemory()) {
7143             error(loc, "output blocks cannot be used in a task shader", "out", "");
7144         }
7145 #endif
7146         break;
7147 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
7148     case EvqPayloadNV:
7149         profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 460, E_GL_NV_ray_tracing, "rayPayloadNV block");
7150         requireStage(loc, (EShLanguageMask)(EShLangRayGenNVMask | EShLangAnyHitNVMask | EShLangClosestHitNVMask | EShLangMissNVMask),
7151             "rayPayloadNV block");
7152         break;
7153     case EvqPayloadInNV:
7154         profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 460, E_GL_NV_ray_tracing, "rayPayloadInNV block");
7155         requireStage(loc, (EShLanguageMask)(EShLangAnyHitNVMask | EShLangClosestHitNVMask | EShLangMissNVMask),
7156             "rayPayloadInNV block");
7157         break;
7158     case EvqHitAttrNV:
7159         profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 460, E_GL_NV_ray_tracing, "hitAttributeNV block");
7160         requireStage(loc, (EShLanguageMask)(EShLangIntersectNVMask | EShLangAnyHitNVMask | EShLangClosestHitNVMask), "hitAttributeNV block");
7161         break;
7162     case EvqCallableDataNV:
7163         profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 460, E_GL_NV_ray_tracing, "callableDataNV block");
7164         requireStage(loc, (EShLanguageMask)(EShLangRayGenNVMask | EShLangClosestHitNVMask | EShLangMissNVMask | EShLangCallableNVMask),
7165             "callableDataNV block");
7166         break;
7167     case EvqCallableDataInNV:
7168         profileRequires(loc, ~EEsProfile, 460, E_GL_NV_ray_tracing, "callableDataInNV block");
7169         requireStage(loc, (EShLanguageMask)(EShLangCallableNVMask), "callableDataInNV block");
7170         break;
7171 #endif
7172     default:
7173         error(loc, "only uniform, buffer, in, or out blocks are supported", blockName->c_str(), "");
7174         break;
7175     }
7176 }
7177 
7178 // Do all block-declaration checking regarding its qualifiers.
blockQualifierCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TQualifier & qualifier,bool)7179 void TParseContext::blockQualifierCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TQualifier& qualifier, bool /*instanceName*/)
7180 {
7181     // The 4.5 specification says:
7182     //
7183     // interface-block :
7184     //    layout-qualifieropt interface-qualifier  block-name { member-list } instance-nameopt ;
7185     //
7186     // interface-qualifier :
7187     //    in
7188     //    out
7189     //    patch in
7190     //    patch out
7191     //    uniform
7192     //    buffer
7193     //
7194     // Note however memory qualifiers aren't included, yet the specification also says
7195     //
7196     // "...memory qualifiers may also be used in the declaration of shader storage blocks..."
7197 
7198     if (qualifier.isInterpolation())
7199         error(loc, "cannot use interpolation qualifiers on an interface block", "flat/smooth/noperspective", "");
7200     if (qualifier.centroid)
7201         error(loc, "cannot use centroid qualifier on an interface block", "centroid", "");
7202     if (qualifier.sample)
7203         error(loc, "cannot use sample qualifier on an interface block", "sample", "");
7204     if (qualifier.invariant)
7205         error(loc, "cannot use invariant qualifier on an interface block", "invariant", "");
7206     if (qualifier.layoutPushConstant)
7207         intermediate.addPushConstantCount();
7208 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
7209     if (qualifier.layoutShaderRecordNV)
7210         intermediate.addShaderRecordNVCount();
7211     if (qualifier.perTaskNV)
7212         intermediate.addTaskNVCount();
7213 #endif
7214 }
7215 
7216 //
7217 // "For a block, this process applies to the entire block, or until the first member
7218 // is reached that has a location layout qualifier. When a block member is declared with a location
7219 // qualifier, its location comes from that qualifier: The member's location qualifier overrides the block-level
7220 // declaration. Subsequent members are again assigned consecutive locations, based on the newest location,
7221 // until the next member declared with a location qualifier. The values used for locations do not have to be
7222 // declared in increasing order."
fixBlockLocations(const TSourceLoc & loc,TQualifier & qualifier,TTypeList & typeList,bool memberWithLocation,bool memberWithoutLocation)7223 void TParseContext::fixBlockLocations(const TSourceLoc& loc, TQualifier& qualifier, TTypeList& typeList, bool memberWithLocation, bool memberWithoutLocation)
7224 {
7225     // "If a block has no block-level location layout qualifier, it is required that either all or none of its members
7226     // have a location layout qualifier, or a compile-time error results."
7227     if (! qualifier.hasLocation() && memberWithLocation && memberWithoutLocation)
7228         error(loc, "either the block needs a location, or all members need a location, or no members have a location", "location", "");
7229     else {
7230         if (memberWithLocation) {
7231             // remove any block-level location and make it per *every* member
7232             int nextLocation = 0;  // by the rule above, initial value is not relevant
7233             if (qualifier.hasAnyLocation()) {
7234                 nextLocation = qualifier.layoutLocation;
7235                 qualifier.layoutLocation = TQualifier::layoutLocationEnd;
7236                 if (qualifier.hasComponent()) {
7237                     // "It is a compile-time error to apply the *component* qualifier to a ... block"
7238                     error(loc, "cannot apply to a block", "component", "");
7239                 }
7240                 if (qualifier.hasIndex()) {
7241                     error(loc, "cannot apply to a block", "index", "");
7242                 }
7243             }
7244             for (unsigned int member = 0; member < typeList.size(); ++member) {
7245                 TQualifier& memberQualifier = typeList[member].type->getQualifier();
7246                 const TSourceLoc& memberLoc = typeList[member].loc;
7247                 if (! memberQualifier.hasLocation()) {
7248                     if (nextLocation >= (int)TQualifier::layoutLocationEnd)
7249                         error(memberLoc, "location is too large", "location", "");
7250                     memberQualifier.layoutLocation = nextLocation;
7251                     memberQualifier.layoutComponent = TQualifier::layoutComponentEnd;
7252                 }
7253                 nextLocation = memberQualifier.layoutLocation + intermediate.computeTypeLocationSize(
7254                                     *typeList[member].type, language);
7255             }
7256         }
7257     }
7258 }
7259 
fixXfbOffsets(TQualifier & qualifier,TTypeList & typeList)7260 void TParseContext::fixXfbOffsets(TQualifier& qualifier, TTypeList& typeList)
7261 {
7262     // "If a block is qualified with xfb_offset, all its
7263     // members are assigned transform feedback buffer offsets. If a block is not qualified with xfb_offset, any
7264     // members of that block not qualified with an xfb_offset will not be assigned transform feedback buffer
7265     // offsets."
7266 
7267     if (! qualifier.hasXfbBuffer() || ! qualifier.hasXfbOffset())
7268         return;
7269 
7270     int nextOffset = qualifier.layoutXfbOffset;
7271     for (unsigned int member = 0; member < typeList.size(); ++member) {
7272         TQualifier& memberQualifier = typeList[member].type->getQualifier();
7273         bool containsDouble = false;
7274         int memberSize = intermediate.computeTypeXfbSize(*typeList[member].type, containsDouble);
7275         // see if we need to auto-assign an offset to this member
7276         if (! memberQualifier.hasXfbOffset()) {
7277             // "if applied to an aggregate containing a double, the offset must also be a multiple of 8"
7278             if (containsDouble)
7279                 RoundToPow2(nextOffset, 8);
7280             memberQualifier.layoutXfbOffset = nextOffset;
7281         } else
7282             nextOffset = memberQualifier.layoutXfbOffset;
7283         nextOffset += memberSize;
7284     }
7285 
7286     // The above gave all block members an offset, so we can take it off the block now,
7287     // which will avoid double counting the offset usage.
7288     qualifier.layoutXfbOffset = TQualifier::layoutXfbOffsetEnd;
7289 }
7290 
7291 // Calculate and save the offset of each block member, using the recursively
7292 // defined block offset rules and the user-provided offset and align.
7293 //
7294 // Also, compute and save the total size of the block. For the block's size, arrayness
7295 // is not taken into account, as each element is backed by a separate buffer.
7296 //
fixBlockUniformOffsets(TQualifier & qualifier,TTypeList & typeList)7297 void TParseContext::fixBlockUniformOffsets(TQualifier& qualifier, TTypeList& typeList)
7298 {
7299     if (!qualifier.isUniformOrBuffer() && !qualifier.isTaskMemory())
7300         return;
7301     if (qualifier.layoutPacking != ElpStd140 && qualifier.layoutPacking != ElpStd430 && qualifier.layoutPacking != ElpScalar)
7302         return;
7303 
7304     int offset = 0;
7305     int memberSize;
7306     for (unsigned int member = 0; member < typeList.size(); ++member) {
7307         TQualifier& memberQualifier = typeList[member].type->getQualifier();
7308         const TSourceLoc& memberLoc = typeList[member].loc;
7309 
7310         // "When align is applied to an array, it effects only the start of the array, not the array's internal stride."
7311 
7312         // modify just the children's view of matrix layout, if there is one for this member
7313         TLayoutMatrix subMatrixLayout = typeList[member].type->getQualifier().layoutMatrix;
7314         int dummyStride;
7315         int memberAlignment = intermediate.getMemberAlignment(*typeList[member].type, memberSize, dummyStride, qualifier.layoutPacking,
7316                                                               subMatrixLayout != ElmNone ? subMatrixLayout == ElmRowMajor : qualifier.layoutMatrix == ElmRowMajor);
7317         if (memberQualifier.hasOffset()) {
7318             // "The specified offset must be a multiple
7319             // of the base alignment of the type of the block member it qualifies, or a compile-time error results."
7320             if (! IsMultipleOfPow2(memberQualifier.layoutOffset, memberAlignment))
7321                 error(memberLoc, "must be a multiple of the member's alignment", "offset", "");
7322 
7323             // GLSL: "It is a compile-time error to specify an offset that is smaller than the offset of the previous
7324             // member in the block or that lies within the previous member of the block"
7325             if (spvVersion.spv == 0) {
7326                 if (memberQualifier.layoutOffset < offset)
7327                     error(memberLoc, "cannot lie in previous members", "offset", "");
7328 
7329                 // "The offset qualifier forces the qualified member to start at or after the specified
7330                 // integral-constant expression, which will be its byte offset from the beginning of the buffer.
7331                 // "The actual offset of a member is computed as
7332                 // follows: If offset was declared, start with that offset, otherwise start with the next available offset."
7333                 offset = std::max(offset, memberQualifier.layoutOffset);
7334             } else {
7335                 // TODO: Vulkan: "It is a compile-time error to have any offset, explicit or assigned,
7336                 // that lies within another member of the block."
7337 
7338                 offset = memberQualifier.layoutOffset;
7339             }
7340         }
7341 
7342         // "The actual alignment of a member will be the greater of the specified align alignment and the standard
7343         // (e.g., std140) base alignment for the member's type."
7344         if (memberQualifier.hasAlign())
7345             memberAlignment = std::max(memberAlignment, memberQualifier.layoutAlign);
7346 
7347         // "If the resulting offset is not a multiple of the actual alignment,
7348         // increase it to the first offset that is a multiple of
7349         // the actual alignment."
7350         RoundToPow2(offset, memberAlignment);
7351         typeList[member].type->getQualifier().layoutOffset = offset;
7352         offset += memberSize;
7353     }
7354 }
7355 
7356 // For an identifier that is already declared, add more qualification to it.
addQualifierToExisting(const TSourceLoc & loc,TQualifier qualifier,const TString & identifier)7357 void TParseContext::addQualifierToExisting(const TSourceLoc& loc, TQualifier qualifier, const TString& identifier)
7358 {
7359     TSymbol* symbol = symbolTable.find(identifier);
7360 
7361     // A forward declaration of a block reference looks to the grammar like adding
7362     // a qualifier to an existing symbol. Detect this and create the block reference
7363     // type with an empty type list, which will be filled in later in
7364     // TParseContext::declareBlock.
7365     if (!symbol && qualifier.layoutBufferReference) {
7366         TTypeList typeList;
7367         TType blockType(&typeList, identifier, qualifier);;
7368         TType blockNameType(EbtReference, blockType, identifier);
7369         TVariable* blockNameVar = new TVariable(&identifier, blockNameType, true);
7370         if (! symbolTable.insert(*blockNameVar)) {
7371             error(loc, "block name cannot redefine a non-block name", blockName->c_str(), "");
7372         }
7373         return;
7374     }
7375 
7376     if (! symbol) {
7377         error(loc, "identifier not previously declared", identifier.c_str(), "");
7378         return;
7379     }
7380     if (symbol->getAsFunction()) {
7381         error(loc, "cannot re-qualify a function name", identifier.c_str(), "");
7382         return;
7383     }
7384 
7385     if (qualifier.isAuxiliary() ||
7386         qualifier.isMemory() ||
7387         qualifier.isInterpolation() ||
7388         qualifier.hasLayout() ||
7389         qualifier.storage != EvqTemporary ||
7390         qualifier.precision != EpqNone) {
7391         error(loc, "cannot add storage, auxiliary, memory, interpolation, layout, or precision qualifier to an existing variable", identifier.c_str(), "");
7392         return;
7393     }
7394 
7395     // For read-only built-ins, add a new symbol for holding the modified qualifier.
7396     // This will bring up an entire block, if a block type has to be modified (e.g., gl_Position inside a block)
7397     if (symbol->isReadOnly())
7398         symbol = symbolTable.copyUp(symbol);
7399 
7400     if (qualifier.invariant) {
7401         if (intermediate.inIoAccessed(identifier))
7402             error(loc, "cannot change qualification after use", "invariant", "");
7403         symbol->getWritableType().getQualifier().invariant = true;
7404         invariantCheck(loc, symbol->getType().getQualifier());
7405     } else if (qualifier.noContraction) {
7406         if (intermediate.inIoAccessed(identifier))
7407             error(loc, "cannot change qualification after use", "precise", "");
7408         symbol->getWritableType().getQualifier().noContraction = true;
7409     } else if (qualifier.specConstant) {
7410         symbol->getWritableType().getQualifier().makeSpecConstant();
7411         if (qualifier.hasSpecConstantId())
7412             symbol->getWritableType().getQualifier().layoutSpecConstantId = qualifier.layoutSpecConstantId;
7413     } else
7414         warn(loc, "unknown requalification", "", "");
7415 }
7416 
addQualifierToExisting(const TSourceLoc & loc,TQualifier qualifier,TIdentifierList & identifiers)7417 void TParseContext::addQualifierToExisting(const TSourceLoc& loc, TQualifier qualifier, TIdentifierList& identifiers)
7418 {
7419     for (unsigned int i = 0; i < identifiers.size(); ++i)
7420         addQualifierToExisting(loc, qualifier, *identifiers[i]);
7421 }
7422 
7423 // Make sure 'invariant' isn't being applied to a non-allowed object.
invariantCheck(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TQualifier & qualifier)7424 void TParseContext::invariantCheck(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TQualifier& qualifier)
7425 {
7426     if (! qualifier.invariant)
7427         return;
7428 
7429     bool pipeOut = qualifier.isPipeOutput();
7430     bool pipeIn = qualifier.isPipeInput();
7431     if (version >= 300 || (profile != EEsProfile && version >= 420)) {
7432         if (! pipeOut)
7433             error(loc, "can only apply to an output", "invariant", "");
7434     } else {
7435         if ((language == EShLangVertex && pipeIn) || (! pipeOut && ! pipeIn))
7436             error(loc, "can only apply to an output, or to an input in a non-vertex stage\n", "invariant", "");
7437     }
7438 }
7439 
7440 //
7441 // Updating default qualifier for the case of a declaration with just a qualifier,
7442 // no type, block, or identifier.
7443 //
updateStandaloneQualifierDefaults(const TSourceLoc & loc,const TPublicType & publicType)7444 void TParseContext::updateStandaloneQualifierDefaults(const TSourceLoc& loc, const TPublicType& publicType)
7445 {
7446     if (publicType.shaderQualifiers.vertices != TQualifier::layoutNotSet) {
7447 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
7448         assert(language == EShLangTessControl || language == EShLangGeometry || language == EShLangMeshNV);
7449 #else
7450         assert(language == EShLangTessControl || language == EShLangGeometry);
7451 #endif
7452         const char* id = (language == EShLangTessControl) ? "vertices" : "max_vertices";
7453 
7454         if (publicType.qualifier.storage != EvqVaryingOut)
7455             error(loc, "can only apply to 'out'", id, "");
7456         if (! intermediate.setVertices(publicType.shaderQualifiers.vertices))
7457             error(loc, "cannot change previously set layout value", id, "");
7458 
7459         if (language == EShLangTessControl)
7460             checkIoArraysConsistency(loc);
7461     }
7462 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
7463     if (publicType.shaderQualifiers.primitives != TQualifier::layoutNotSet) {
7464         assert(language == EShLangMeshNV);
7465         const char* id = "max_primitives";
7466 
7467         if (publicType.qualifier.storage != EvqVaryingOut)
7468             error(loc, "can only apply to 'out'", id, "");
7469         if (! intermediate.setPrimitives(publicType.shaderQualifiers.primitives))
7470             error(loc, "cannot change previously set layout value", id, "");
7471     }
7472 #endif
7473     if (publicType.shaderQualifiers.invocations != TQualifier::layoutNotSet) {
7474         if (publicType.qualifier.storage != EvqVaryingIn)
7475             error(loc, "can only apply to 'in'", "invocations", "");
7476         if (! intermediate.setInvocations(publicType.shaderQualifiers.invocations))
7477             error(loc, "cannot change previously set layout value", "invocations", "");
7478     }
7479     if (publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry != ElgNone) {
7480         if (publicType.qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingIn) {
7481             switch (publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry) {
7482             case ElgPoints:
7483             case ElgLines:
7484             case ElgLinesAdjacency:
7485             case ElgTriangles:
7486             case ElgTrianglesAdjacency:
7487             case ElgQuads:
7488             case ElgIsolines:
7489 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
7490                 if (language == EShLangMeshNV) {
7491                     error(loc, "cannot apply to input", TQualifier::getGeometryString(publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry), "");
7492                     break;
7493                 }
7494 #endif
7495                 if (intermediate.setInputPrimitive(publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry)) {
7496                     if (language == EShLangGeometry)
7497                         checkIoArraysConsistency(loc);
7498                 } else
7499                     error(loc, "cannot change previously set input primitive", TQualifier::getGeometryString(publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry), "");
7500                 break;
7501             default:
7502                 error(loc, "cannot apply to input", TQualifier::getGeometryString(publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry), "");
7503             }
7504         } else if (publicType.qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingOut) {
7505             switch (publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry) {
7506 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
7507             case ElgLines:
7508             case ElgTriangles:
7509                 if (language != EShLangMeshNV) {
7510                     error(loc, "cannot apply to 'out'", TQualifier::getGeometryString(publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry), "");
7511                     break;
7512                 }
7513 #endif
7514                 // Fall through
7515             case ElgPoints:
7516             case ElgLineStrip:
7517             case ElgTriangleStrip:
7518                 if (! intermediate.setOutputPrimitive(publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry))
7519                     error(loc, "cannot change previously set output primitive", TQualifier::getGeometryString(publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry), "");
7520                 break;
7521             default:
7522                 error(loc, "cannot apply to 'out'", TQualifier::getGeometryString(publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry), "");
7523             }
7524         } else
7525             error(loc, "cannot apply to:", TQualifier::getGeometryString(publicType.shaderQualifiers.geometry), GetStorageQualifierString(publicType.qualifier.storage));
7526     }
7527     if (publicType.shaderQualifiers.spacing != EvsNone) {
7528         if (publicType.qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingIn) {
7529             if (! intermediate.setVertexSpacing(publicType.shaderQualifiers.spacing))
7530                 error(loc, "cannot change previously set vertex spacing", TQualifier::getVertexSpacingString(publicType.shaderQualifiers.spacing), "");
7531         } else
7532             error(loc, "can only apply to 'in'", TQualifier::getVertexSpacingString(publicType.shaderQualifiers.spacing), "");
7533     }
7534     if (publicType.shaderQualifiers.order != EvoNone) {
7535         if (publicType.qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingIn) {
7536             if (! intermediate.setVertexOrder(publicType.shaderQualifiers.order))
7537                 error(loc, "cannot change previously set vertex order", TQualifier::getVertexOrderString(publicType.shaderQualifiers.order), "");
7538         } else
7539             error(loc, "can only apply to 'in'", TQualifier::getVertexOrderString(publicType.shaderQualifiers.order), "");
7540     }
7541     if (publicType.shaderQualifiers.pointMode) {
7542         if (publicType.qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingIn)
7543             intermediate.setPointMode();
7544         else
7545             error(loc, "can only apply to 'in'", "point_mode", "");
7546     }
7547     for (int i = 0; i < 3; ++i) {
7548         if (publicType.shaderQualifiers.localSize[i] > 1) {
7549             if (publicType.qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingIn) {
7550                 if (! intermediate.setLocalSize(i, publicType.shaderQualifiers.localSize[i]))
7551                     error(loc, "cannot change previously set size", "local_size", "");
7552                 else {
7553                     int max = 0;
7554                     if (language == EShLangCompute) {
7555                         switch (i) {
7556                         case 0: max = resources.maxComputeWorkGroupSizeX; break;
7557                         case 1: max = resources.maxComputeWorkGroupSizeY; break;
7558                         case 2: max = resources.maxComputeWorkGroupSizeZ; break;
7559                         default: break;
7560                         }
7561                         if (intermediate.getLocalSize(i) > (unsigned int)max)
7562                             error(loc, "too large; see gl_MaxComputeWorkGroupSize", "local_size", "");
7563                     }
7564 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
7565                     else if (language == EShLangMeshNV) {
7566                         switch (i) {
7567                         case 0: max = resources.maxMeshWorkGroupSizeX_NV; break;
7568                         case 1: max = resources.maxMeshWorkGroupSizeY_NV; break;
7569                         case 2: max = resources.maxMeshWorkGroupSizeZ_NV; break;
7570                         default: break;
7571                         }
7572                         if (intermediate.getLocalSize(i) > (unsigned int)max)
7573                             error(loc, "too large; see gl_MaxMeshWorkGroupSizeNV", "local_size", "");
7574                     }
7575                     else if (language == EShLangTaskNV) {
7576                         switch (i) {
7577                         case 0: max = resources.maxTaskWorkGroupSizeX_NV; break;
7578                         case 1: max = resources.maxTaskWorkGroupSizeY_NV; break;
7579                         case 2: max = resources.maxTaskWorkGroupSizeZ_NV; break;
7580                         default: break;
7581                         }
7582                         if (intermediate.getLocalSize(i) > (unsigned int)max)
7583                             error(loc, "too large; see gl_MaxTaskWorkGroupSizeNV", "local_size", "");
7584                     }
7585 #endif
7586                     else {
7587                         assert(0);
7588                     }
7589 
7590                     // Fix the existing constant gl_WorkGroupSize with this new information.
7591                     TVariable* workGroupSize = getEditableVariable("gl_WorkGroupSize");
7592                     if (workGroupSize != nullptr)
7593                         workGroupSize->getWritableConstArray()[i].setUConst(intermediate.getLocalSize(i));
7594                 }
7595             } else
7596                 error(loc, "can only apply to 'in'", "local_size", "");
7597         }
7598         if (publicType.shaderQualifiers.localSizeSpecId[i] != TQualifier::layoutNotSet) {
7599             if (publicType.qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingIn) {
7600                 if (! intermediate.setLocalSizeSpecId(i, publicType.shaderQualifiers.localSizeSpecId[i]))
7601                     error(loc, "cannot change previously set size", "local_size", "");
7602             } else
7603                 error(loc, "can only apply to 'in'", "local_size id", "");
7604             // Set the workgroup built-in variable as a specialization constant
7605             TVariable* workGroupSize = getEditableVariable("gl_WorkGroupSize");
7606             if (workGroupSize != nullptr)
7607                 workGroupSize->getWritableType().getQualifier().specConstant = true;
7608         }
7609     }
7610     if (publicType.shaderQualifiers.earlyFragmentTests) {
7611         if (publicType.qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingIn)
7612             intermediate.setEarlyFragmentTests();
7613         else
7614             error(loc, "can only apply to 'in'", "early_fragment_tests", "");
7615     }
7616     if (publicType.shaderQualifiers.postDepthCoverage) {
7617         if (publicType.qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingIn)
7618             intermediate.setPostDepthCoverage();
7619         else
7620             error(loc, "can only apply to 'in'", "post_coverage_coverage", "");
7621     }
7622     if (publicType.shaderQualifiers.blendEquation) {
7623         if (publicType.qualifier.storage != EvqVaryingOut)
7624             error(loc, "can only apply to 'out'", "blend equation", "");
7625     }
7626 
7627 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
7628     if (publicType.shaderQualifiers.layoutDerivativeGroupQuads &&
7629         publicType.shaderQualifiers.layoutDerivativeGroupLinear) {
7630         error(loc, "cannot be both specified", "derivative_group_quadsNV and derivative_group_linearNV", "");
7631     }
7632 
7633     if (publicType.shaderQualifiers.layoutDerivativeGroupQuads) {
7634         if (publicType.qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingIn) {
7635             if ((intermediate.getLocalSize(0) & 1) ||
7636                 (intermediate.getLocalSize(1) & 1))
7637                 error(loc, "requires local_size_x and local_size_y to be multiple of two", "derivative_group_quadsNV", "");
7638             else
7639                 intermediate.setLayoutDerivativeMode(LayoutDerivativeGroupQuads);
7640         }
7641         else
7642             error(loc, "can only apply to 'in'", "derivative_group_quadsNV", "");
7643     }
7644     if (publicType.shaderQualifiers.layoutDerivativeGroupLinear) {
7645         if (publicType.qualifier.storage == EvqVaryingIn) {
7646             if((intermediate.getLocalSize(0) *
7647                 intermediate.getLocalSize(1) *
7648                 intermediate.getLocalSize(2)) % 4 != 0)
7649                 error(loc, "requires total group size to be multiple of four", "derivative_group_linearNV", "");
7650             else
7651                 intermediate.setLayoutDerivativeMode(LayoutDerivativeGroupLinear);
7652         }
7653         else
7654             error(loc, "can only apply to 'in'", "derivative_group_linearNV", "");
7655     }
7656 #endif
7657     const TQualifier& qualifier = publicType.qualifier;
7658 
7659     if (qualifier.isAuxiliary() ||
7660         qualifier.isMemory() ||
7661         qualifier.isInterpolation() ||
7662         qualifier.precision != EpqNone)
7663         error(loc, "cannot use auxiliary, memory, interpolation, or precision qualifier in a default qualifier declaration (declaration with no type)", "qualifier", "");
7664     // "The offset qualifier can only be used on block members of blocks..."
7665     // "The align qualifier can only be used on blocks or block members..."
7666     if (qualifier.hasOffset() ||
7667         qualifier.hasAlign())
7668         error(loc, "cannot use offset or align qualifiers in a default qualifier declaration (declaration with no type)", "layout qualifier", "");
7669 
7670     layoutQualifierCheck(loc, qualifier);
7671 
7672     switch (qualifier.storage) {
7673     case EvqUniform:
7674         if (qualifier.hasMatrix())
7675             globalUniformDefaults.layoutMatrix = qualifier.layoutMatrix;
7676         if (qualifier.hasPacking())
7677             globalUniformDefaults.layoutPacking = qualifier.layoutPacking;
7678         break;
7679     case EvqBuffer:
7680         if (qualifier.hasMatrix())
7681             globalBufferDefaults.layoutMatrix = qualifier.layoutMatrix;
7682         if (qualifier.hasPacking())
7683             globalBufferDefaults.layoutPacking = qualifier.layoutPacking;
7684         break;
7685     case EvqVaryingIn:
7686         break;
7687     case EvqVaryingOut:
7688         if (qualifier.hasStream())
7689             globalOutputDefaults.layoutStream = qualifier.layoutStream;
7690         if (qualifier.hasXfbBuffer())
7691             globalOutputDefaults.layoutXfbBuffer = qualifier.layoutXfbBuffer;
7692         if (globalOutputDefaults.hasXfbBuffer() && qualifier.hasXfbStride()) {
7693             if (! intermediate.setXfbBufferStride(globalOutputDefaults.layoutXfbBuffer, qualifier.layoutXfbStride))
7694                 error(loc, "all stride settings must match for xfb buffer", "xfb_stride", "%d", qualifier.layoutXfbBuffer);
7695         }
7696         break;
7697     default:
7698         error(loc, "default qualifier requires 'uniform', 'buffer', 'in', or 'out' storage qualification", "", "");
7699         return;
7700     }
7701 
7702     if (qualifier.hasBinding())
7703         error(loc, "cannot declare a default, include a type or full declaration", "binding", "");
7704     if (qualifier.hasAnyLocation())
7705         error(loc, "cannot declare a default, use a full declaration", "location/component/index", "");
7706     if (qualifier.hasXfbOffset())
7707         error(loc, "cannot declare a default, use a full declaration", "xfb_offset", "");
7708     if (qualifier.layoutPushConstant)
7709         error(loc, "cannot declare a default, can only be used on a block", "push_constant", "");
7710     if (qualifier.layoutBufferReference)
7711         error(loc, "cannot declare a default, can only be used on a block", "buffer_reference", "");
7712     if (qualifier.hasSpecConstantId())
7713         error(loc, "cannot declare a default, can only be used on a scalar", "constant_id", "");
7714 #ifdef NV_EXTENSIONS
7715     if (qualifier.layoutShaderRecordNV)
7716         error(loc, "cannot declare a default, can only be used on a block", "shaderRecordNV", "");
7717 #endif
7718 }
7719 
7720 //
7721 // Take the sequence of statements that has been built up since the last case/default,
7722 // put it on the list of top-level nodes for the current (inner-most) switch statement,
7723 // and follow that by the case/default we are on now.  (See switch topology comment on
7724 // TIntermSwitch.)
7725 //
wrapupSwitchSubsequence(TIntermAggregate * statements,TIntermNode * branchNode)7726 void TParseContext::wrapupSwitchSubsequence(TIntermAggregate* statements, TIntermNode* branchNode)
7727 {
7728     TIntermSequence* switchSequence = switchSequenceStack.back();
7729 
7730     if (statements) {
7731         if (switchSequence->size() == 0)
7732             error(statements->getLoc(), "cannot have statements before first case/default label", "switch", "");
7733         statements->setOperator(EOpSequence);
7734         switchSequence->push_back(statements);
7735     }
7736     if (branchNode) {
7737         // check all previous cases for the same label (or both are 'default')
7738         for (unsigned int s = 0; s < switchSequence->size(); ++s) {
7739             TIntermBranch* prevBranch = (*switchSequence)[s]->getAsBranchNode();
7740             if (prevBranch) {
7741                 TIntermTyped* prevExpression = prevBranch->getExpression();
7742                 TIntermTyped* newExpression = branchNode->getAsBranchNode()->getExpression();
7743                 if (prevExpression == nullptr && newExpression == nullptr)
7744                     error(branchNode->getLoc(), "duplicate label", "default", "");
7745                 else if (prevExpression != nullptr &&
7746                           newExpression != nullptr &&
7747                          prevExpression->getAsConstantUnion() &&
7748                           newExpression->getAsConstantUnion() &&
7749                          prevExpression->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst() ==
7750                           newExpression->getAsConstantUnion()->getConstArray()[0].getIConst())
7751                     error(branchNode->getLoc(), "duplicated value", "case", "");
7752             }
7753         }
7754         switchSequence->push_back(branchNode);
7755     }
7756 }
7757 
7758 //
7759 // Turn the top-level node sequence built up of wrapupSwitchSubsequence9)
7760 // into a switch node.
7761 //
addSwitch(const TSourceLoc & loc,TIntermTyped * expression,TIntermAggregate * lastStatements)7762 TIntermNode* TParseContext::addSwitch(const TSourceLoc& loc, TIntermTyped* expression, TIntermAggregate* lastStatements)
7763 {
7764     profileRequires(loc, EEsProfile, 300, nullptr, "switch statements");
7765     profileRequires(loc, ENoProfile, 130, nullptr, "switch statements");
7766 
7767     wrapupSwitchSubsequence(lastStatements, nullptr);
7768 
7769     if (expression == nullptr ||
7770         (expression->getBasicType() != EbtInt && expression->getBasicType() != EbtUint) ||
7771         expression->getType().isArray() || expression->getType().isMatrix() || expression->getType().isVector())
7772             error(loc, "condition must be a scalar integer expression", "switch", "");
7773 
7774     // If there is nothing to do, drop the switch but still execute the expression
7775     TIntermSequence* switchSequence = switchSequenceStack.back();
7776     if (switchSequence->size() == 0)
7777         return expression;
7778 
7779     if (lastStatements == nullptr) {
7780         // This was originally an ERRROR, because early versions of the specification said
7781         // "it is an error to have no statement between a label and the end of the switch statement."
7782         // The specifications were updated to remove this (being ill-defined what a "statement" was),
7783         // so, this became a warning.  However, 3.0 tests still check for the error.
7784         if (profile == EEsProfile && version <= 300 && ! relaxedErrors())
7785             error(loc, "last case/default label not followed by statements", "switch", "");
7786         else
7787             warn(loc, "last case/default label not followed by statements", "switch", "");
7788 
7789         // emulate a break for error recovery
7790         lastStatements = intermediate.makeAggregate(intermediate.addBranch(EOpBreak, loc));
7791         lastStatements->setOperator(EOpSequence);
7792         switchSequence->push_back(lastStatements);
7793     }
7794 
7795     TIntermAggregate* body = new TIntermAggregate(EOpSequence);
7796     body->getSequence() = *switchSequenceStack.back();
7797     body->setLoc(loc);
7798 
7799     TIntermSwitch* switchNode = new TIntermSwitch(expression, body);
7800     switchNode->setLoc(loc);
7801 
7802     return switchNode;
7803 }
7804 
7805 } // end namespace glslang
7806